3 @setfilename coreutils.info
4 @settitle @sc{gnu} Coreutils
9 @include constants.texi
11 @c Define new indices.
15 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
25 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
26 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options.
27 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
28 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
31 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
32 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
33 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
35 @dircategory Individual utilities
37 * arch: (coreutils)arch invocation. Print machine hardware name.
38 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
39 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
40 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
41 * chcon: (coreutils)chcon invocation. Change SELinux CTX of files.
42 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
43 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change file permissions.
44 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners/groups.
45 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
46 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
47 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
48 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
49 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
50 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
51 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
52 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
53 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system disk usage.
54 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
55 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
56 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip last file name component.
57 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report on disk usage.
58 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
59 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
60 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
61 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
62 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
63 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
64 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
65 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
66 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
67 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
68 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
69 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
70 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
71 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy and change attributes.
72 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
73 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
74 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
75 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
76 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
77 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
78 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
79 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
80 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
81 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
82 * mktemp: (coreutils)mktemp invocation. Create temporary files.
83 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
84 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
85 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
86 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
87 * nproc: (coreutils)nproc invocation. Print the number of processors.
88 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
89 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
90 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
91 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
92 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
93 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
94 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
95 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
96 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
97 * realpath: (coreutils)readpath invocation. Print resolved file names.
98 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
99 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
100 * runcon: (coreutils)runcon invocation. Run in specified SELinux CTX.
101 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
102 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
103 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
104 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
105 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
106 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
107 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
108 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into pieces.
109 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
110 * stdbuf: (coreutils)stdbuf invocation. Modify stdio buffering.
111 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
112 * su: (coreutils)su invocation. Modify user and group ID.
113 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
114 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Synchronize memory and disk.
115 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
116 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
117 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
118 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
119 * timeout: (coreutils)timeout invocation. Run with time limit.
120 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
121 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
122 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
123 * truncate: (coreutils)truncate invocation. Shrink/extend size of a file.
124 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
125 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
126 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
127 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
128 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
129 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
130 * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. Print uptime and load.
131 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
132 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
133 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
134 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
135 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
136 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
140 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the @sc{gnu} core
141 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
143 Copyright @copyright{} 1994-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
146 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
147 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
148 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
149 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
150 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
151 Free Documentation License''.
156 @title @sc{gnu} @code{Coreutils}
157 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
158 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
159 @author David MacKenzie et al.
162 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
175 @cindex core utilities
176 @cindex text utilities
177 @cindex shell utilities
178 @cindex file utilities
181 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors
182 * Common options:: Common options
183 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od base64
184 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
185 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
186 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum md5sum sha1sum sha2
187 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
188 * Operating on fields:: cut paste join
189 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
190 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
191 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
192 * Special file types:: mkdir rmdir unlink mkfifo mknod ln link readlink
193 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
194 * Disk usage:: df du stat sync truncate
195 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
196 * Conditions:: false true test expr
198 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk mktemp realpath
199 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
200 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
201 * System context:: date arch nproc uname hostname hostid uptime
202 * SELinux context:: chcon runcon
203 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup stdbuf su timeout
204 * Process control:: kill
206 * Numeric operations:: factor seq
207 * File permissions:: Access modes
208 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
209 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy
210 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
211 * Concept index:: General index
214 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
218 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure
219 * Backup options:: Backup options
220 * Block size:: Block size
221 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation
222 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals
223 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
224 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
225 * Target directory:: Target directory
226 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
227 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
228 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
229 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
231 Output of entire files
233 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files
234 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse
235 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files
236 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats
237 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
239 Formatting file contents
241 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text
242 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing
243 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
245 Output of parts of files
247 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files
248 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files
249 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
250 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces
254 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts
255 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts
256 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
257 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests
258 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests
259 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests
261 Operating on sorted files
263 * sort invocation:: Sort text files
264 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files
265 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files
266 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line
267 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents
268 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort
270 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
272 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior
273 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations
274 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection
275 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields
276 * Compatibility in ptx:: The @acronym{GNU} extensions to @command{ptx}
280 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines
281 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files
282 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field
284 Operating on characters
286 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
287 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces
288 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs
290 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
292 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters
293 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another
294 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting
298 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
299 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
300 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
301 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
303 @command{ls}: List directory contents
305 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
306 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
307 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
308 * Details about version sort:: More details about version sort
309 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
310 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
314 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
315 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
316 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
317 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
318 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
319 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
323 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
324 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
325 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
326 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
327 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
328 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
329 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
330 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
332 Changing file attributes
334 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
335 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
336 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
337 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
341 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage
342 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
343 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
344 * sync invocation:: Synchronize data on disk with memory
345 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file
349 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
350 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
351 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
355 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
356 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
357 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
358 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
360 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
362 * File type tests:: File type tests
363 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
364 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
365 * String tests:: String tests
366 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
368 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
370 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
371 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
372 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
373 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
377 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
379 File name manipulation
381 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
382 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component
383 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability
384 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory
385 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names
389 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
390 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
391 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
392 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
394 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
396 * Control:: Control settings
397 * Input:: Input settings
398 * Output:: Output settings
399 * Local:: Local settings
400 * Combination:: Combination settings
401 * Characters:: Special characters
402 * Special:: Special settings
406 * id invocation:: Print user identity
407 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
408 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
409 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
410 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
411 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
415 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name
416 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
417 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors
418 * uname invocation:: Print system information
419 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
420 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier
421 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load
423 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
425 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
426 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
427 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
428 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
429 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock
430 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time
431 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
432 * Examples of date:: Examples
436 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
437 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
439 Modified command invocation
441 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
442 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
443 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
444 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
445 * stdbuf invocation:: Run a command with modified I/O buffering
446 * su invocation:: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
447 * timeout invocation:: Run a command with a time limit
451 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
455 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
459 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
460 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
464 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits
465 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits
466 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers
467 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories
471 * General date syntax:: Common rules
472 * Calendar date items:: 19 Dec 1994
473 * Time of day items:: 9:20pm
474 * Time zone items:: @sc{est}, @sc{pdt}, @sc{gmt}
475 * Day of week items:: Monday and others
476 * Relative items in date strings:: next tuesday, 2 years ago
477 * Pure numbers in date strings:: 19931219, 1440
478 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @@1078100502
479 * Specifying time zone rules:: TZ="America/New_York", TZ="UTC0"
480 * Authors of parse_datetime:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al
482 Opening the software toolbox
484 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
485 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
486 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
487 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
488 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
489 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
490 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
494 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
501 @chapter Introduction
503 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
504 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
505 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire @sc{gnu} community
508 @cindex @acronym{POSIX}
509 The @sc{gnu} utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
510 @acronym{POSIX} standard.
511 @cindex bugs, reporting
512 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}. Remember
513 to include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
514 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
515 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong. Diffs are welcome, but
516 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
517 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
523 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
526 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
527 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
528 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
529 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
530 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
531 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
532 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
533 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
534 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
535 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
536 insights to the overall process.
539 @chapter Common options
543 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
546 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
547 @cindex backups, making
548 @xref{Backup options}.
549 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
552 @macro optBackupSuffix
553 @item -S @var{suffix}
554 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
557 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
558 @xref{Backup options}.
561 @macro optTargetDirectory
562 @item -t @var{directory}
563 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
565 @opindex --target-directory
566 @cindex target directory
567 @cindex destination directory
568 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
569 @xref{Target directory}.
572 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
574 @itemx --no-target-directory
576 @opindex --no-target-directory
577 @cindex target directory
578 @cindex destination directory
579 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
580 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
588 @cindex output @sc{nul}-byte-terminated lines
589 Output a zero byte (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) at the end of each line,
590 rather than a newline. This option enables other programs to parse the
591 output of @command{\cmd\} even when that output would contain data
592 with embedded newlines.
599 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
600 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
601 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
602 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
603 @option{--human-readable} option if
604 you prefer powers of 1024.
607 @macro optHumanReadable
609 @itemx --human-readable
611 @opindex --human-readable
612 @cindex human-readable output
613 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
614 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
615 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
616 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
619 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
620 @itemx @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}}
621 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
622 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
623 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
624 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
627 @macro mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{cmd}
628 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
629 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
630 Due to shell aliases and built-in @command{\cmd\} functions, using an
631 unadorned @command{\cmd\} interactively or in a script may get you
632 different functionality than that described here. Invoke it via
633 @command{env} (i.e., @code{env \cmd\ @dots{}}) to avoid interference
638 @macro multiplierSuffixes{varName}
639 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
640 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
642 @samp{b} => 512 ("blocks")
643 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
644 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
645 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
646 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
647 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
648 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
650 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
653 @c FIXME: same as above, but no ``blocks'' line.
654 @macro multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{varName}
655 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
656 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
658 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
659 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
660 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
661 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
662 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
663 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
665 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
668 @cindex common options
670 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
671 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
672 described here. (In fact, every @sc{gnu} program accepts (or should accept)
675 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
676 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
677 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
678 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
679 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
680 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
681 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
683 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
684 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
685 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
686 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
687 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
688 specify a command that itself contains options.
690 Most programs that accept long options recognize unambiguous
691 abbreviations of those options. For example, @samp{rmdir
692 --ignore-fail-on-non-empty} can be invoked as @samp{rmdir
693 --ignore-fail} or even @samp{rmdir --i}. Ambiguous options, such as
694 @samp{ls --h}, are identified as such.
696 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
697 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument. For
698 these programs, abbreviations of the long options are not always recognized.
705 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
709 @cindex version number, finding
710 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
714 @cindex option delimiter
715 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
716 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
717 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
721 @cindex standard input
722 @cindex standard output
723 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
724 stands for standard input, or for standard output if that is clear from
725 the context. For example, @samp{sort -} reads from standard input,
726 and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}, and @samp{tee -} writes an
727 extra copy of its input to standard output. Unless otherwise
728 specified, @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
732 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
733 * Backup options:: -b -S, in some programs.
734 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and --block-size, in some programs.
735 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation.
736 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals using the --signal option.
737 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
738 * Random sources:: --random-source, in some programs.
739 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory, in some programs.
740 * Trailing slashes:: --strip-trailing-slashes, in some programs.
741 * Traversing symlinks:: -H, -L, or -P, in some programs.
742 * Treating / specially:: --preserve-root and --no-preserve-root.
743 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @dots{}
744 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the @acronym{POSIX} standard.
752 An exit status of zero indicates success,
753 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
756 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
757 that can be used to change how other commands work.
758 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
759 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value---typically
760 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as @acronym{POSIX}
761 requires only that it be nonzero.
763 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
764 other exit status values and a few associate different
765 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
766 Here are some of the exceptions:
767 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr}, @command{nice},
768 @command{nohup}, @command{printenv}, @command{sort}, @command{stdbuf},
769 @command{su}, @command{test}, @command{timeout}, @command{tty}.
773 @section Backup options
775 @cindex backup options
777 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
778 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
779 before writing new versions.
780 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
781 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
786 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
789 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
790 @cindex backups, making
791 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
792 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
793 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
794 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
795 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
796 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
797 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
799 Note that the short form of this option, @option{-b} does not accept any
800 argument. Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing}.
802 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
803 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
804 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
805 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
806 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
811 @opindex none @r{backup method}
816 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
817 Always make numbered backups.
821 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
822 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
827 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
828 Always make simple backups. Please note @samp{never} is not to be
829 confused with @samp{none}.
833 @item -S @var{suffix}
834 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
837 @cindex backup suffix
838 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
839 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
840 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
841 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
842 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
851 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
852 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
853 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
854 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
855 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
857 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
860 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
861 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
862 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
863 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
865 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
866 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
871 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
872 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
873 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
876 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
877 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
880 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
881 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
882 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
883 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
884 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
887 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
888 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
889 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
894 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
895 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
896 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
899 @cindex human-readable output
902 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
903 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
904 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
905 that are upward compatible with the
906 @uref{http://www.bipm.org/en/si/si_brochure/chapter3/prefixes.html, SI prefixes}
907 for decimal multiples and with the
908 @uref{http://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, ISO/IEC 80000-13
909 (formerly IEC 60027-2) prefixes} for binary multiples.
911 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
912 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
913 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
914 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
915 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
918 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
919 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
920 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
921 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
922 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
923 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
926 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
927 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
928 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
929 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
930 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
931 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
932 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
934 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
935 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
936 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
939 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Y}
940 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
944 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
945 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
949 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
950 kibibyte: @math{2^{10} = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
951 @samp{k} and the ISO/IEC 80000-13 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
952 @acronym{POSIX} use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
954 @cindex megabyte, definition of
955 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
958 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
959 mebibyte: @math{2^{20} = 1,048,576}.
961 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
962 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
965 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
966 gibibyte: @math{2^{30} = 1,073,741,824}.
968 @cindex terabyte, definition of
969 terabyte: @math{10^{12} = 1,000,000,000,000}.
972 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
973 tebibyte: @math{2^{40} = 1,099,511,627,776}.
975 @cindex petabyte, definition of
976 petabyte: @math{10^{15} = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
979 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
980 pebibyte: @math{2^{50} = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
982 @cindex exabyte, definition of
983 exabyte: @math{10^{18} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
986 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
987 exbibyte: @math{2^{60} = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
989 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
990 zettabyte: @math{10^{21} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
993 @math{2^{70} = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
995 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
996 yottabyte: @math{10^{24} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
999 @math{2^{80} = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
1004 @opindex --block-size
1005 @opindex --human-readable
1008 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
1009 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
1010 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
1011 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
1012 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
1013 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
1014 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}.
1016 @node Floating point
1017 @section Floating point numbers
1018 @cindex floating point
1019 @cindex IEEE floating point
1021 Commands that accept or produce floating point numbers employ the
1022 floating point representation of the underlying system, and suffer
1023 from rounding error, overflow, and similar floating-point issues.
1024 Almost all modern systems use IEEE-754 floating point, and it is
1025 typically portable to assume IEEE-754 behavior these days. IEEE-754
1026 has positive and negative infinity, distinguishes positive from
1027 negative zero, and uses special values called NaNs to represent
1028 invalid computations such as dividing zero by itself. For more
1029 information, please see David Goldberg's paper
1030 @uref{http://@/www.validlab.com/@/goldberg/@/paper.pdf, What Every
1031 Computer Scientist Should Know About Floating-Point Arithmetic}.
1034 Commands that accept floating point numbers as options, operands or
1035 input use the standard C functions @code{strtod} and @code{strtold} to
1036 convert from text to floating point numbers. These floating point
1037 numbers therefore can use scientific notation like @code{1.0e-34} and
1038 @code{-10e100}. Modern C implementations also accept hexadecimal
1039 floating point numbers such as @code{-0x.ep-3}, which stands for
1040 @minus{}14/16 times @math{2^-3}, which equals @minus{}0.109375. The
1041 @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale determines the decimal-point character.
1042 @xref{Parsing of Floats,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
1044 @node Signal specifications
1045 @section Signal specifications
1046 @cindex signals, specifying
1048 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
1049 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
1050 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
1051 @samp{SIG}. The case of the letters is ignored. The following signal names
1052 and numbers are supported on all @acronym{POSIX} compliant systems:
1058 2. Terminal interrupt.
1064 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
1072 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
1073 numbers. All systems conforming to @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 also
1074 support the following signals:
1078 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
1080 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
1082 Continue executing, if stopped.
1084 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
1086 Illegal Instruction.
1088 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
1090 Invalid memory reference.
1092 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
1096 Background process attempting read.
1098 Background process attempting write.
1100 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
1102 User-defined signal 1.
1104 User-defined signal 2.
1108 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XSI} extension
1109 also support the following signals:
1115 Profiling timer expired.
1119 Trace/breakpoint trap.
1121 Virtual timer expired.
1123 CPU time limit exceeded.
1125 File size limit exceeded.
1129 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XRT} extension
1130 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
1131 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
1133 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
1134 @section chown and chgrp: Disambiguating user names and IDs
1135 @cindex user names, disambiguating
1136 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
1137 @cindex group names, disambiguating
1138 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
1139 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
1141 Since the @var{owner} and @var{group} arguments to @command{chown} and
1142 @command{chgrp} may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
1144 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
1145 @footnote{Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.}
1146 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID?
1147 @acronym{POSIX} requires that @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1148 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
1149 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID.
1150 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
1151 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
1152 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
1153 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
1154 1000---not what you intended.
1156 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp} provide a way to work around this,
1157 that at the same time may result in a significant performance improvement
1158 by eliminating a database look-up.
1159 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
1160 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
1164 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
1168 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1169 skip the name look-up process for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
1170 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
1171 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
1173 @node Random sources
1174 @section Sources of random data
1176 @cindex random sources
1178 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
1179 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
1180 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
1181 make this selection.
1183 By default these commands use an internal pseudorandom generator
1184 initialized by a small amount of entropy, but can be directed to use
1185 an external source with the @option{--random-source=@var{file}} option.
1186 An error is reported if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes.
1188 For example, the device file @file{/dev/urandom} could be used as the
1189 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
1190 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
1191 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
1192 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
1193 cryptographically secure pseudorandom number generator. But be aware
1194 that this device is not designed for bulk random data generation
1195 and is relatively slow.
1197 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
1198 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
1199 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
1200 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
1203 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
1204 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1205 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1207 @node Target directory
1208 @section Target directory
1210 @cindex target directory
1212 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1213 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1214 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1215 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1216 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1217 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1218 allow more fine-grained control:
1223 @itemx --no-target-directory
1224 @opindex --no-target-directory
1225 @cindex target directory
1226 @cindex destination directory
1227 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1228 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1229 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1230 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1231 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1232 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1233 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1234 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1235 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1237 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1238 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1239 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1241 @item -t @var{directory}
1242 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
1243 @opindex --target-directory
1244 @cindex target directory
1245 @cindex destination directory
1246 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1249 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1250 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1251 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1252 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1253 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1255 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1256 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1257 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1258 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1259 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1260 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1261 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1262 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1265 The @w{@kbd{--target-directory}} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1266 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1267 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1268 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1271 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1274 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1275 If you use the @sc{gnu} @command{find} program, you can move those
1276 files too, with this command:
1279 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1283 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1284 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1285 some other special characters.
1286 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1287 @sc{gnu} @command{find} and @sc{gnu} @command{xargs}:
1290 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1291 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1298 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1299 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1300 options cannot be combined.
1302 @node Trailing slashes
1303 @section Trailing slashes
1305 @cindex trailing slashes
1307 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1308 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1309 operating on it. The @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}} option enables
1312 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1313 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1314 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1315 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1316 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1317 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1318 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1319 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1320 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1321 be the default, it is required by @acronym{POSIX} and is consistent with
1322 other parts of that standard.
1324 @node Traversing symlinks
1325 @section Traversing symlinks
1327 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1329 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1330 @c FIXME: note that 'du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1331 @c different meaning.
1332 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1333 option is also specified.
1334 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1336 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1337 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1338 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1340 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1341 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1342 a symlink or its referent.
1349 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse if on the command line
1350 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1351 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1358 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1359 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1360 that is encountered.
1367 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1368 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1369 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1370 or @option{-P} is specified.
1377 @node Treating / specially
1378 @section Treating @file{/} specially
1380 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1381 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1382 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1383 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1384 legitimate uses for such a command,
1385 @sc{gnu} @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1386 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1387 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1388 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1389 @option{--preserve-option}, is safer for most purposes.
1391 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1392 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1393 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1394 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1395 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1396 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1397 interrupt them. Tradition and @acronym{POSIX} require these commands
1398 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1399 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1400 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1401 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1403 Note that the @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1404 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1405 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1407 @node Special built-in utilities
1408 @section Special built-in utilities
1410 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1411 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1412 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1413 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1414 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1415 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1418 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1419 by @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2004.
1422 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1423 return set shift times trap unset}
1426 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1427 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1428 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1430 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1431 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1432 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1433 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1435 @node Standards conformance
1436 @section Standards conformance
1438 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1439 In a few cases, the @sc{gnu} utilities' default behavior is
1440 incompatible with the @acronym{POSIX} standard. To suppress these
1441 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1442 variable. Unless you are checking for @acronym{POSIX} conformance, you
1443 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1445 Newer versions of @acronym{POSIX} are occasionally incompatible with older
1446 versions. For example, older versions of @acronym{POSIX} required the
1447 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1448 fields in each input line, but starting with @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001
1449 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1450 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1453 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1454 The @sc{gnu} utilities normally conform to the version of @acronym{POSIX}
1455 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1456 different version of @acronym{POSIX}, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1457 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1458 the year and month the standard was adopted. Three values are currently
1459 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1460 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.2-1992, @samp{200112} stands for @acronym{POSIX}
1461 1003.1-2001, and @samp{200809} stands for @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2008.
1462 For example, if you have a newer system but are running software
1463 that assumes an older version of @acronym{POSIX} and uses @samp{sort +1}
1464 or @samp{tail +10}, you can work around any compatibility problems by setting
1465 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=199209} in your environment.
1467 @node Output of entire files
1468 @chapter Output of entire files
1470 @cindex output of entire files
1471 @cindex entire files, output of
1473 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1477 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1478 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1479 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1480 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1481 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1484 @node cat invocation
1485 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1488 @cindex concatenate and write files
1489 @cindex copying files
1491 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1492 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1495 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1498 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1506 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1509 @itemx --number-nonblank
1511 @opindex --number-nonblank
1512 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1516 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1521 @opindex --show-ends
1522 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1528 Number all output lines, starting with 1. This option is ignored
1529 if @option{-b} is in effect.
1532 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1534 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1535 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1536 Suppress repeated adjacent empty lines; output just one empty line
1541 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1546 @opindex --show-tabs
1547 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1551 Ignored; for @acronym{POSIX} compatibility.
1554 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1556 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1557 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1558 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1563 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1564 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1565 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1566 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1567 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1568 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1569 if standard output is a terminal.
1576 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1579 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1584 @node tac invocation
1585 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1588 @cindex reversing files
1590 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1591 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1592 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1595 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1598 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1599 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1600 the record that it follows in the file.
1602 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1610 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1611 precedes in the file.
1617 Treat the separator string as a regular expression. Users of @command{tac}
1618 on MS-DOS/MS-Windows should note that, since @command{tac} reads files in
1619 binary mode, each line of a text file might end with a CR/LF pair
1620 instead of the Unix-style LF.
1622 @item -s @var{separator}
1623 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1625 @opindex --separator
1626 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1634 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1637 @cindex numbering lines
1638 @cindex line numbering
1640 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1641 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1642 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1645 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1648 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1649 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) pages; by default, the
1650 line number is reset to 1 at the top of each logical page. @command{nl}
1651 treats all of the input files as a single document; it does not reset
1652 line numbers or logical pages between files.
1654 @cindex headers, numbering
1655 @cindex body, numbering
1656 @cindex footers, numbering
1657 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1658 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1659 style from the others.
1661 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1662 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1673 The two characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1674 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern and
1675 length of each string cannot be changed.
1677 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1678 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1679 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1680 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1682 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1686 @item -b @var{style}
1687 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1689 @opindex --body-numbering
1690 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1691 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1692 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1693 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1699 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1701 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1703 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1704 expression @var{bre}.
1705 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1709 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1711 @opindex --section-delimiter
1712 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1713 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1714 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1715 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1716 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1718 @item -f @var{style}
1719 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1721 @opindex --footer-numbering
1722 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1724 @item -h @var{style}
1725 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1727 @opindex --header-numbering
1728 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1730 @item -i @var{number}
1731 @itemx --line-increment=@var{number}
1733 @opindex --line-increment
1734 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1736 @item -l @var{number}
1737 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1739 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1740 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1741 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1742 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1743 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1744 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1745 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1748 @item -n @var{format}
1749 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1751 @opindex --number-format
1752 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1756 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1757 left justified, no leading zeros;
1759 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1760 right justified, no leading zeros;
1762 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1763 right justified, leading zeros.
1767 @itemx --no-renumber
1769 @opindex --no-renumber
1770 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1772 @item -s @var{string}
1773 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1775 @opindex --number-separator
1776 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1777 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1779 @item -v @var{number}
1780 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1782 @opindex --starting-line-number
1783 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1785 @item -w @var{number}
1786 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1788 @opindex --number-width
1789 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1797 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1800 @cindex octal dump of files
1801 @cindex hex dump of files
1802 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1803 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1805 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1806 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1810 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1811 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1812 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}]@c
1813 [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1816 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1817 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1818 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1819 printed as a single octal number.
1821 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1822 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1823 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1824 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1825 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1826 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1827 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1829 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1830 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1831 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
1832 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
1835 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1839 @item -A @var{radix}
1840 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
1842 @opindex --address-radix
1843 @cindex radix for file offsets
1844 @cindex file offset radix
1845 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
1846 be one of the following:
1856 none (do not print offsets).
1859 The default is octal.
1861 @item -j @var{bytes}
1862 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
1864 @opindex --skip-bytes
1865 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
1866 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
1867 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
1869 @multiplierSuffixes{bytes}
1871 @item -N @var{bytes}
1872 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
1874 @opindex --read-bytes
1875 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
1876 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
1878 @item -S @var{bytes}
1879 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
1882 @cindex string constants, outputting
1883 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
1884 least @var{bytes} consecutive @acronym{ASCII} graphic characters,
1885 followed by a zero byte (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}).
1886 Prefixes and suffixes on @var{bytes} are interpreted as for the
1889 If @var{n} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
1892 @itemx --format=@var{type}
1895 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
1896 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
1897 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
1898 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
1899 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
1900 in the order that you specified.
1902 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
1903 of the @acronym{ASCII} character representation of the printable characters
1904 to the output line generated by the type specification.
1908 named character, ignoring high-order bit
1910 @acronym{ASCII} character or backslash escape,
1914 floating point (@pxref{Floating point})
1923 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
1924 newline, and @samp{nul} for a zero byte. Only the least significant
1925 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
1926 Type @code{c} outputs
1927 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
1930 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
1931 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
1932 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
1933 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
1934 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
1935 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
1936 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
1949 For floating point (@code{f}):
1961 @itemx --output-duplicates
1963 @opindex --output-duplicates
1964 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
1965 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
1966 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
1967 indicate the elision.
1970 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
1973 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
1974 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
1977 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
1978 omitted, the default is 32.
1982 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
1983 @sc{gnu} @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
1984 specification options. These options accumulate.
1990 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
1994 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
1998 Output as @acronym{ASCII} characters or backslash escapes. Equivalent to
2003 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
2007 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
2011 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
2015 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
2019 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
2023 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
2027 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
2030 @opindex --traditional
2031 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
2032 accepted. The following syntax:
2035 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
2039 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
2040 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
2041 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
2042 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
2043 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
2050 @node base64 invocation
2051 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data
2054 @cindex base64 encoding
2056 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2057 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
2058 printable @acronym{ASCII} characters to represent binary data.
2062 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2063 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2066 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
2067 The format conforms to
2068 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc4648.txt, RFC 4648}.
2070 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2075 @itemx --wrap=@var{cols}
2079 @cindex column to wrap data after
2080 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{cols} characters. This must be
2083 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
2084 disable line wrapping altogether.
2090 @cindex Decode base64 data
2091 @cindex Base64 decoding
2092 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
2093 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
2094 output will be the original data.
2097 @itemx --ignore-garbage
2099 @opindex --ignore-garbage
2100 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
2101 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
2102 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
2103 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
2110 @node Formatting file contents
2111 @chapter Formatting file contents
2113 @cindex formatting file contents
2115 These commands reformat the contents of files.
2118 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
2119 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
2120 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
2124 @node fmt invocation
2125 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
2128 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
2129 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
2130 @cindex text, reformatting
2132 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
2133 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
2136 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2139 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
2140 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
2142 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
2143 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
2144 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
2147 @cindex line-breaking
2148 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
2149 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
2150 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
2151 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
2152 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
2153 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
2154 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
2155 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
2156 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
2157 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
2158 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
2159 @cite{Software---Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
2162 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2167 @itemx --crown-margin
2169 @opindex --crown-margin
2170 @cindex crown margin
2171 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
2172 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
2173 line with that of the second line.
2176 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
2178 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
2179 @cindex tagged paragraphs
2180 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
2181 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
2182 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
2188 @opindex --split-only
2189 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
2190 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
2191 being unduly combined.
2194 @itemx --uniform-spacing
2196 @opindex --uniform-spacing
2197 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
2198 between sentences to two spaces.
2201 @itemx -w @var{width}
2202 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2203 @opindex -@var{width}
2206 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75 or @var{goal}
2207 plus 10, if @var{goal} is provided).
2209 @itemx -g @var{goal}
2210 @itemx --goal=@var{goal}
2213 @command{fmt} initially tries to make lines @var{goal} characters wide.
2214 By default, this is 7% shorter than @var{width}.
2216 @item -p @var{prefix}
2217 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2218 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2219 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2220 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2221 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2222 leaving the code unchanged.
2230 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2233 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2234 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2235 @cindex merging files in parallel
2237 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2238 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2239 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2240 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2243 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2247 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2248 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2249 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2250 The default @var{page_length} is 66
2251 lines. The default number of text lines is therefore 56.
2252 The text line of the header takes the form
2253 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2254 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2255 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2256 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2257 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2258 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2259 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2262 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2263 feeds produce empty pages.
2265 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2266 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2267 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2269 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2270 truncate lines in that case.
2272 The following changes were made in version 1.22i and apply to later
2273 versions of @command{pr}:
2274 @c FIXME: this whole section here sounds very awkward to me. I
2275 @c made a few small changes, but really it all needs to be redone. - Brian
2276 @c OK, I fixed another sentence or two, but some of it I just don't understand.
2281 Some small @var{letter options} (@option{-s}, @option{-w}) have been
2282 redefined for better @acronym{POSIX} compliance. The output of some further
2283 cases has been adapted to other Unix systems. These changes are not
2284 compatible with earlier versions of the program.
2287 Some @var{new capital letter} options (@option{-J}, @option{-S}, @option{-W})
2288 have been introduced to turn off unexpected interferences of small letter
2289 options. The @option{-N} option and the second argument @var{last_page}
2290 of @samp{+FIRST_PAGE} offer more flexibility. The detailed handling of
2291 form feeds set in the input files requires the @option{-T} option.
2294 Capital letter options override small letter ones.
2297 Some of the option-arguments (compare @option{-s}, @option{-e},
2298 @option{-i}, @option{-n}) cannot be specified as separate arguments from the
2299 preceding option letter (already stated in the @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2302 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2306 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2307 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2308 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain ':'
2309 @c The 'info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2310 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2311 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2312 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2313 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2314 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2315 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2316 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2317 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2318 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2319 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2320 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2324 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2325 @opindex -@var{column}
2327 @cindex down columns
2328 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2329 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2330 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2331 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2332 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2333 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2334 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2335 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2336 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2337 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2338 with @option{-m} option.
2344 @cindex across columns
2345 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2346 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2347 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2350 @itemx --show-control-chars
2352 @opindex --show-control-chars
2353 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2354 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2355 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2358 @itemx --double-space
2360 @opindex --double-space
2361 @cindex double spacing
2362 Double space the output.
2364 @item -D @var{format}
2365 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2366 @cindex time formats
2367 @cindex formatting times
2368 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2369 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}. @xref{date invocation}.
2370 Except for directives, which start with
2371 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2372 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2373 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2375 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2377 The default date format is @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example,
2378 @samp{2001-12-04 23:59});
2379 but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2380 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the @acronym{POSIX}
2381 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2382 @samp{Dec@ @ 4 23:59 2001}.
2385 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2386 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2387 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2388 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
2390 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2391 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2393 @opindex --expand-tabs
2395 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2396 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2397 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2405 @opindex --form-feed
2406 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. This does
2407 not alter the default page length of 66 lines.
2409 @item -h @var{header}
2410 @itemx --header=@var{header}
2413 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2414 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2415 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2417 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2418 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2420 @opindex --output-tabs
2422 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2423 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2424 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2430 @opindex --join-lines
2431 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2432 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2433 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2434 no column alignment used; may be used with
2435 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2436 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2437 to disentangle the old (@acronym{POSIX}-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2438 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2441 @item -l @var{page_length}
2442 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2445 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2446 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2447 than or equal to 10, the header and footer are omitted, as if the
2448 @option{-t} option had been given.
2454 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2455 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2456 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2458 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2459 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2460 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2461 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2462 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2463 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2464 the middle blank part.
2466 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2467 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2469 @opindex --number-lines
2470 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2471 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2472 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2473 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2474 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2475 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2476 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2477 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2478 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2479 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2480 printed with single column output only. The TAB width varies
2481 with the TAB position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2482 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2483 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2484 The TAB width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2485 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2486 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2487 @var{number-separator} TAB. The tabification depends upon the output
2490 @item -N @var{line_number}
2491 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2493 @opindex --first-line-number
2494 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2495 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2497 @item -o @var{margin}
2498 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2501 @cindex indenting lines
2503 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2504 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2505 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2506 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2509 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2511 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2512 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2513 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2515 @item -s[@var{char}]
2516 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2518 @opindex --separator
2519 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2520 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2521 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2522 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2523 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2524 @option{-w} is set. This is a @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2527 @item -S[@var{string}]
2528 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2530 @opindex --sep-string
2531 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2532 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2533 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2534 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2536 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2537 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}).
2538 If no @samp{@var{string}} argument is specified, @samp{""} is assumed.
2541 @itemx --omit-header
2543 @opindex --omit-header
2544 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2545 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2546 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2547 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2548 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2549 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2550 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2553 @itemx --omit-pagination
2555 @opindex --omit-pagination
2556 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2557 set in the input files.
2560 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2562 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2563 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2565 @item -w @var{page_width}
2566 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2569 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2570 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). @option{-s[CHAR]} turns
2571 off the default page width and any line truncation and column alignment.
2572 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2573 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2574 A @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2576 @item -W @var{page_width}
2577 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2579 @opindex --page_width
2580 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters. That's valid with and
2581 without a column option. Text lines are truncated, unless @option{-J}
2582 is used. Together with one of the three column options
2583 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2584 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2585 don't affect the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2586 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2587 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2588 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}. The header
2589 line is never truncated.
2596 @node fold invocation
2597 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2600 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2601 @cindex folding long input lines
2603 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2604 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2608 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2611 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2612 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2614 @cindex screen columns
2615 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2616 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2617 return sets the column to zero.
2619 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2627 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2628 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2635 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2636 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2637 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2639 @item -w @var{width}
2640 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2643 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2645 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2646 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2654 @node Output of parts of files
2655 @chapter Output of parts of files
2657 @cindex output of parts of files
2658 @cindex parts of files, output of
2660 These commands output pieces of the input.
2663 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2664 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2665 * split invocation:: Split a file into pieces.
2666 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2669 @node head invocation
2670 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2673 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2674 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2676 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2677 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2678 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2681 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2684 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2685 one-line header consisting of:
2688 ==> @var{file name} <==
2692 before the output for each @var{file}.
2694 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2699 @itemx --bytes=@var{k}
2702 Print the first @var{k} bytes, instead of initial lines.
2703 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{-},
2704 print all but the last @var{k} bytes of each file.
2705 @multiplierSuffixes{k}
2708 @itemx --lines=@var{k}
2711 Output the first @var{k} lines.
2712 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{-},
2713 print all but the last @var{k} lines of each file.
2714 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2722 Never print file name headers.
2728 Always print file name headers.
2732 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
2733 @option{-@var{count}@var{options}}, which is recognized only if it is
2734 specified first. @var{count} is a decimal number optionally followed
2735 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
2736 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
2737 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{count}}
2738 or @option{-n @var{count}} instead. If your script must also run on
2739 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
2740 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
2746 @node tail invocation
2747 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
2750 @cindex last part of files, outputting
2752 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
2753 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2754 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
2757 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2760 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
2761 one-line header consisting of:
2764 ==> @var{file name} <==
2768 before the output for each @var{file}.
2770 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
2771 @sc{gnu} @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
2772 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
2773 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
2774 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
2775 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
2776 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
2777 the @sc{gnu} @command{tac} command.
2779 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2784 @itemx --bytes=@var{k}
2787 Output the last @var{k} bytes, instead of final lines.
2788 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2789 @var{k}th byte from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2790 @multiplierSuffixes{k}
2793 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
2796 @cindex growing files
2797 @vindex name @r{follow option}
2798 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
2799 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
2800 presumably because the file is growing.
2801 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
2802 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
2805 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
2806 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
2808 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
2809 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
2810 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
2811 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
2812 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file, perhaps by reopening it
2813 periodically to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
2814 Note that the inotify-based implementation handles this case without
2815 the need for any periodic reopening.
2817 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
2818 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
2819 and resumes tracking the end of the file from the newly-determined endpoint.
2821 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
2822 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
2823 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
2824 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
2825 periodically to see if the file reappears.
2826 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
2827 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
2828 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
2831 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
2832 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
2834 The @option{-f} option is ignored if
2835 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2836 Likewise, the @option{-f} option has no effect for any
2837 operand specified as @samp{-}, when standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2839 With kernel inotify support, output is triggered by file changes
2840 and is generally very prompt.
2841 Otherwise, @command{tail} sleeps for one second between checks---
2842 use @option{--sleep-interval=@var{n}} to change that default---which can
2843 make the output appear slightly less responsive or bursty.
2844 When using tail without inotify support, you can make it more responsive
2845 by using a sub-second sleep interval, e.g., via an alias like this:
2848 alias tail='tail -s.1'
2853 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
2854 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
2855 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
2859 This option is useful mainly when following by name (i.e., with
2860 @option{--follow=name}).
2861 Without this option, when tail encounters a file that doesn't
2862 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
2863 never checks it again.
2865 @itemx --sleep-interval=@var{number}
2866 @opindex --sleep-interval
2867 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
2868 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
2870 Historical implementations of @command{tail} have required that
2871 @var{number} be an integer. However, GNU @command{tail} accepts
2872 an arbitrary floating point number. @xref{Floating point}.
2873 When @command{tail} uses inotify, this polling-related option
2874 is usually ignored. However, if you also specify @option{--pid=@var{p}},
2875 @command{tail} checks whether process @var{p} is alive at least
2876 every @var{number} seconds.
2878 @itemx --pid=@var{pid}
2880 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
2881 @var{pid}, of the sole writer of all @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly
2882 after that process terminates, tail will also terminate. This will
2883 work properly only if the writer and the tailing process are running on
2884 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
2885 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
2886 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
2887 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
2891 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
2894 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
2895 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
2896 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
2897 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
2898 Note that @option{--pid} cannot be supported on some systems; @command{tail}
2899 will print a warning if this is the case.
2901 @itemx --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
2902 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
2903 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
2904 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
2905 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
2906 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
2907 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
2908 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
2909 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
2910 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
2911 This option is meaningful only when polling (i.e., without inotify)
2912 and when following by name.
2915 @itemx --lines=@var{k}
2918 Output the last @var{k} lines.
2919 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2920 @var{k}th line from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2921 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2929 Never print file name headers.
2935 Always print file name headers.
2939 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
2940 @samp{tail -[@var{count}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
2941 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
2942 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
2943 file. In the option, @var{count} is an optional decimal number optionally
2944 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
2945 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
2946 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
2948 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
2949 On older systems, the leading @samp{-} can be replaced by @samp{+} in
2950 the obsolete option syntax with the same meaning as in counts, and
2951 obsolete usage overrides normal usage when the two conflict.
2952 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
2953 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
2956 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
2957 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{count}[b]}, @option{-n
2958 @var{count}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
2959 run on hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, you can often
2960 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
2961 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
2962 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
2963 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
2965 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
2966 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the @acronym{POSIX}
2967 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
2968 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
2969 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
2970 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
2971 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
2976 @node split invocation
2977 @section @command{split}: Split a file into pieces.
2980 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
2981 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
2983 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive or interleaved
2984 sections of @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input}
2985 is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
2988 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
2991 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
2992 left over for the last section), into each output file.
2994 @cindex output file name prefix
2995 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
2996 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
2997 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
2998 sorted order by file name produces the original input file (except
2999 @option{-nr/@var{n}}). By default split will initially create files
3000 with two generated suffix characters, and will increase this width by two
3001 when the next most significant position reaches the last character.
3002 (@samp{yz}, @samp{zaaa}, @samp{zaab}, @dots{}). In this way an arbitrary
3003 number of output files are supported, which sort as described above,
3004 even in the presence of an @option{--additional-suffix} option.
3005 If the @option{-a} option is specified and the output file names are
3006 exhausted, @command{split} reports an error without deleting the
3007 output files that it did create.
3009 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3013 @item -l @var{lines}
3014 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
3017 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
3019 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
3020 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use
3021 @option{-l @var{lines}} instead.
3024 @itemx --bytes=@var{size}
3027 Put @var{size} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
3028 @multiplierSuffixes{size}
3031 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{size}
3033 @opindex --line-bytes
3034 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
3035 possible without exceeding @var{size} bytes. Individual lines longer than
3036 @var{size} bytes are broken into multiple files.
3037 @var{size} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes} option.
3039 @itemx --filter=@var{command}
3041 With this option, rather than simply writing to each output file,
3042 write through a pipe to the specified shell @var{command} for each output file.
3043 @var{command} should use the $FILE environment variable, which is set
3044 to a different output file name for each invocation of the command.
3045 For example, imagine that you have a 1TiB compressed file
3046 that, if uncompressed, would be too large to reside on disk,
3047 yet you must split it into individually-compressed pieces
3048 of a more manageable size.
3049 To do that, you might run this command:
3052 xz -dc BIG.xz | split -b200G --filter='xz > $FILE.xz' - big-
3055 Assuming a 10:1 compression ratio, that would create about fifty 20GiB files
3056 with names @file{big-aa.xz}, @file{big-ab.xz}, @file{big-ac.xz}, etc.
3058 @item -n @var{chunks}
3059 @itemx --number=@var{chunks}
3063 Split @var{input} to @var{chunks} output files where @var{chunks} may be:
3066 @var{n} generate @var{n} files based on current size of @var{input}
3067 @var{k}/@var{n} only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3068 l/@var{n} generate @var{n} files without splitting lines
3069 l/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3070 r/@var{n} like @samp{l} but use round robin distribution
3071 r/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3074 Any excess bytes remaining after dividing the @var{input}
3075 into @var{n} chunks, are assigned to the last chunk.
3076 Any excess bytes appearing after the initial calculation are discarded
3077 (except when using @samp{r} mode).
3079 All @var{n} files are created even if there are fewer than @var{n} lines,
3080 or the @var{input} is truncated.
3082 For @samp{l} mode, chunks are approximately @var{input} size / @var{n}.
3083 The @var{input} is partitioned into @var{n} equal sized portions, with
3084 the last assigned any excess. If a line @emph{starts} within a partition
3085 it is written completely to the corresponding file. Since lines
3086 are not split even if they overlap a partition, the files written
3087 can be larger or smaller than the partition size, and even empty
3088 if a line is so long as to completely overlap the partition.
3090 For @samp{r} mode, the size of @var{input} is irrelevant,
3091 and so can be a pipe for example.
3093 @item -a @var{length}
3094 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
3096 @opindex --suffix-length
3097 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. If a @var{length} of 0 is specified,
3098 this is the same as if (any previous) @option{-a} was not specified, and
3099 thus enables the default behavior, which starts the suffix length at 2,
3100 and unless @option{-n} or @option{--numeric-suffixes=@var{from}} is
3101 specified, will auto increase the length by 2 as required.
3104 @itemx --numeric-suffixes[=@var{from}]
3106 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
3107 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters. The numerical
3108 suffix counts from @var{from} if specified, 0 otherwise.
3109 Note specifying a @var{from} value also disables the default
3110 auto suffix length expansion described above, and so you may also
3111 want to specify @option{-a} to allow suffixes beyond @samp{99}.
3113 @itemx --additional-suffix=@var{suffix}
3114 @opindex --additional-suffix
3115 Append an additional @var{suffix} to output file names. @var{suffix}
3116 must not contain slash.
3119 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3121 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3122 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. This can happen
3123 with the @option{--number} option if a file is (truncated to be) shorter
3124 than the number requested, or if a line is so long as to completely
3125 span a chunk. The output file sequence numbers, always run consecutively
3126 even when this option is specified.
3131 @opindex --unbuffered
3132 Immediately copy input to output in @option{--number r/...} mode,
3133 which is a much slower mode of operation.
3137 Write a diagnostic just before each output file is opened.
3143 Here are a few examples to illustrate how the
3144 @option{--number} (@option{-n}) option works:
3146 Notice how, by default, one line may be split onto two or more:
3149 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -n3 k; head xa?
3162 Use the "l/" modifier to suppress that:
3165 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nl/3 k; head xa?
3178 Use the "r/" modifier to distribute lines in a round-robin fashion:
3181 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nr/3 k; head xa?
3194 You can also extract just the Kth chunk.
3195 This extracts and prints just the 7th "chunk" of 33:
3198 $ seq 100 > k; split -nl/7/33 k
3205 @node csplit invocation
3206 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
3209 @cindex context splitting
3210 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
3212 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
3213 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3216 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
3219 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
3220 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
3221 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
3222 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
3223 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
3226 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
3227 output file after it has been created.
3229 The types of pattern arguments are:
3234 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
3235 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
3236 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
3237 file once for each repeat.
3239 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
3240 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
3241 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
3242 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer.
3243 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
3244 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
3245 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
3247 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
3248 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
3249 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
3251 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
3252 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
3253 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
3254 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
3259 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
3260 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
3261 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
3262 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
3263 original input file.
3265 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
3266 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
3267 that it has created so far before it exits.
3269 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3273 @item -f @var{prefix}
3274 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
3277 @cindex output file name prefix
3278 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
3280 @item -b @var{suffix}
3281 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
3284 @cindex output file name suffix
3285 Use @var{suffix} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
3286 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
3287 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
3288 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specifications,
3289 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
3290 binary unsigned integer argument to readable form. The format letters
3291 @samp{d} and @samp{i} are aliases for @samp{u}, and the
3292 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
3293 entire @var{suffix} is given (with the current output file number) to
3294 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
3295 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
3296 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
3298 @item -n @var{digits}
3299 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
3302 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
3303 long instead of the default 2.
3308 @opindex --keep-files
3309 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
3312 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3314 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3315 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
3316 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
3317 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
3318 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
3319 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
3330 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
3336 Here is an example of its usage.
3337 First, create an empty directory for the exercise,
3344 Now, split the sequence of 1..14 on lines that end with 0 or 5:
3347 $ seq 14 | csplit - '/[05]$/' '@{*@}'
3353 Each number printed above is the size of an output
3354 file that csplit has just created.
3355 List the names of those output files:
3362 Use @command{head} to show their contents:
3387 @node Summarizing files
3388 @chapter Summarizing files
3390 @cindex summarizing files
3392 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
3396 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
3397 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
3398 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
3399 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
3400 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
3401 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
3406 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3410 @cindex character count
3414 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, whitespace-separated
3415 words, and newlines in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none
3416 are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3419 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3422 @cindex total counts
3423 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3424 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. If
3425 more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3426 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}. The
3427 counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3428 maximum line length.
3429 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3430 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3431 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3432 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3433 However, as a @acronym{GNU} extension, if only one count is printed,
3434 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3436 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3437 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3438 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3445 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3447 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3448 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3449 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths. The line lengths here
3450 are measured in screen columns, according to the current locale and
3451 assuming tab positions in every 8th column.
3453 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3461 Print only the byte counts.
3467 Print only the character counts.
3473 Print only the word counts.
3479 Print only the newline counts.
3482 @itemx --max-line-length
3484 @opindex --max-line-length
3485 Print only the maximum line lengths.
3487 @macro filesZeroFromOption{cmd,withTotalOption,subListOutput}
3488 @itemx --files0-from=@var{file}
3489 @opindex --files0-from=@var{file}
3490 @c This is commented out to avoid a texi2dvi failure.
3491 @c texi2dvi (GNU Texinfo 4.11) 1.104
3492 @c @cindex including files from @command{\cmd\}
3493 Disallow processing files named on the command line, and instead process
3494 those named in file @var{file}; each name being terminated by a zero byte
3495 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}).
3496 This is useful \withTotalOption\
3497 when the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3499 In such cases, running @command{\cmd\} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3500 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{\cmd\} print
3501 \subListOutput\ for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3502 One way to produce a list of @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} terminated file
3503 names is with @sc{gnu}
3504 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
3505 If @var{file} is @samp{-} then the @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} terminated
3506 file names are read from standard input.
3508 @filesZeroFromOption{wc,,a total}
3510 For example, to find the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or
3511 @file{.h} file in the current hierarchy, do this:
3514 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 |
3515 wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3523 @node sum invocation
3524 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3527 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3528 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3530 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3531 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3534 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3537 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3538 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If more than one @var{file}
3539 is given, file names are also printed (by default). (With the
3540 @option{--sysv} option, corresponding file names are printed when there is
3541 at least one file argument.)
3543 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3544 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3547 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3553 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3554 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3555 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3556 given, it has no effect.
3562 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3563 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3564 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3568 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3569 next section) is preferable in new applications.
3574 @node cksum invocation
3575 @section @command{cksum}: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
3578 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
3579 @cindex CRC checksum
3581 @command{cksum} computes a cyclic redundancy check (CRC) checksum for each
3582 given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for a
3583 @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3586 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3589 @command{cksum} prints the CRC checksum for each file along with the number
3590 of bytes in the file, and the file name unless no arguments were given.
3592 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files
3593 transferred by unreliable means (e.g., netnews) have not been corrupted,
3594 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
3595 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
3598 The CRC algorithm is specified by the @acronym{POSIX} standard. It is not
3599 compatible with the BSD or System V @command{sum} algorithms (see the
3600 previous section); it is more robust.
3602 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
3608 @node md5sum invocation
3609 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
3613 @cindex 128-bit checksum
3614 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
3615 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
3616 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
3618 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
3619 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
3621 Note: The MD5 digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
3622 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
3623 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical MD5
3624 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered secure
3625 against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a given MD5
3626 fingerprint is considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how
3627 to modify certain files, including digital certificates, so that they
3628 appear valid when signed with an MD5 digest.
3629 For more secure hashes, consider using SHA-2. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3631 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
3632 @command{md5sum} computes the checksum for the standard input.
3633 @command{md5sum} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
3634 consistent. Synopsis:
3637 md5sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3640 For each @var{file}, @samp{md5sum} outputs the MD5 checksum, a flag
3641 indicating binary or text input mode, and the file name.
3642 If @var{file} contains a backslash or newline, the
3643 line is started with a backslash, and each problematic character in
3644 the file name is escaped with a backslash, making the output
3645 unambiguous even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
3646 If @var{file} is omitted or specified as @samp{-}, standard input is read.
3648 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3656 @cindex binary input files
3657 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
3658 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
3659 On systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not distinguish between binary
3660 and text files, this option merely flags each input mode as binary:
3661 the MD5 checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
3662 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
3663 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
3667 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
3668 @var{file} (or from stdin if no @var{file} was specified) and report
3669 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
3670 The input to this mode of @command{md5sum} is usually the output of
3671 a prior, checksum-generating run of @samp{md5sum}.
3672 Each valid line of input consists of an MD5 checksum, a binary/text
3673 flag, and then a file name.
3674 Binary mode is indicated with @samp{*}, text with @samp{ } (space).
3675 For each such line, @command{md5sum} reads the named file and computes its
3676 MD5 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
3677 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
3678 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
3679 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
3680 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
3681 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
3682 a warning is issued to standard error.
3683 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
3684 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
3685 an MD5 checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
3686 line is found, @command{md5sum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
3687 it exits successfully.
3691 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3692 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3693 When verifying checksums, don't generate an 'OK' message per successfully
3694 checked file. Files that fail the verification are reported in the
3695 default one-line-per-file format. If there is any checksum mismatch,
3696 print a warning summarizing the failures to standard error.
3700 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3701 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3702 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
3703 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
3704 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
3706 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
3707 MD5 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
3708 indicating there was a failure.
3714 @cindex text input files
3715 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
3716 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
3717 This option is the default on systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not
3718 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
3719 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
3726 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3727 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted MD5 checksum lines.
3728 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
3733 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3734 When verifying checksums,
3735 if one or more input line is invalid,
3736 exit nonzero after all warnings have been issued.
3743 @node sha1sum invocation
3744 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
3748 @cindex 160-bit checksum
3749 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
3750 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
3751 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
3753 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified
3754 @var{file}. The usage and options of this command are precisely the
3755 same as for @command{md5sum}. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3757 Note: The SHA-1 digest is more secure than MD5, and no collisions of
3758 it are known (different files having the same fingerprint). However,
3759 it is known that they can be produced with considerable, but not
3760 unreasonable, resources. For this reason, it is generally considered
3761 that SHA-1 should be gradually phased out in favor of the more secure
3762 SHA-2 hash algorithms. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3765 @node sha2 utilities
3766 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
3773 @cindex 224-bit checksum
3774 @cindex 256-bit checksum
3775 @cindex 384-bit checksum
3776 @cindex 512-bit checksum
3777 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
3778 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
3779 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
3780 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
3781 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
3782 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
3783 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
3784 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
3785 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
3786 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
3787 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
3788 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
3790 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
3791 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
3792 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
3793 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes. The usage and options of
3794 these commands are precisely the same as for @command{md5sum}.
3795 @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3797 Note: The SHA384 and SHA512 digests are considerably slower to
3798 compute, especially on 32-bit computers, than SHA224 or SHA256.
3801 @node Operating on sorted files
3802 @chapter Operating on sorted files
3804 @cindex operating on sorted files
3805 @cindex sorted files, operations on
3807 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
3810 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
3811 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
3812 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
3813 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
3814 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
3815 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
3819 @node sort invocation
3820 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
3823 @cindex sorting files
3825 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
3826 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
3827 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
3831 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3834 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
3835 and check for sortedness. The following options change the operation
3842 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
3845 @cindex checking for sortedness
3846 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
3847 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
3848 exit with a status of 1.
3849 Otherwise, exit successfully.
3850 At most one input file can be given.
3853 @itemx --check=quiet
3854 @itemx --check=silent
3857 @cindex checking for sortedness
3858 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
3859 exit with status 1 otherwise.
3860 At most one input file can be given.
3861 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
3867 @cindex merging sorted files
3868 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
3869 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
3870 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
3875 @cindex sort stability
3876 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
3877 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
3878 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields, in the
3879 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
3880 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
3881 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
3882 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
3883 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
3884 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
3885 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
3886 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
3887 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
3888 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
3892 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
3893 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
3894 use a non-@acronym{POSIX} locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
3895 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
3896 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
3897 environment variable to @samp{C}. Note that setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
3898 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
3899 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
3900 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
3901 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
3902 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
3904 @sc{gnu} @command{sort} (as specified for all @sc{gnu} utilities) has no
3905 limit on input line length or restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
3906 In addition, if the final byte of an input file is not a newline, @sc{gnu}
3907 @command{sort} silently supplies one. A line's trailing newline is not
3908 part of the line for comparison purposes.
3910 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
3914 0 if no error occurred
3915 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
3916 2 if an error occurred
3920 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
3921 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
3922 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
3923 the environment variable.
3925 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
3926 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
3927 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
3928 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
3929 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-@acronym{POSIX}
3930 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
3931 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
3936 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
3938 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
3939 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
3941 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
3942 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3943 can change this. Note blanks may be ignored by your locale's collating
3944 rules, but without this option they will be significant for character
3945 positions specified in keys with the @option{-k} option.
3948 @itemx --dictionary-order
3950 @opindex --dictionary-order
3951 @cindex dictionary order
3952 @cindex phone directory order
3953 @cindex telephone directory order
3955 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
3956 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
3957 By default letters and digits are those of @acronym{ASCII} and a blank
3958 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
3961 @itemx --ignore-case
3963 @opindex --ignore-case
3964 @cindex ignoring case
3965 @cindex case folding
3967 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
3968 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
3969 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
3970 When used with @option{--unique} those lower case equivalent lines are
3971 thrown away. (There is currently no way to throw away the upper case
3972 equivalent instead. (Any @option{--reverse} given would only affect
3973 the final result, after the throwing away.))
3976 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
3977 @itemx --sort=general-numeric
3979 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
3981 @cindex general numeric sort
3983 Sort numerically, converting a prefix of each line to a long
3984 double-precision floating point number. @xref{Floating point}.
3985 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
3986 Use the following collating sequence:
3990 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
3992 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
3993 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
3997 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
4002 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
4003 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
4004 converting to floating point.
4007 @itemx --human-numeric-sort
4008 @itemx --sort=human-numeric
4010 @opindex --human-numeric-sort
4012 @cindex human numeric sort
4014 Sort numerically, first by numeric sign (negative, zero, or positive);
4015 then by @acronym{SI} suffix (either empty, or @samp{k} or @samp{K}, or
4016 one of @samp{MGTPEZY}, in that order; @pxref{Block size}); and finally
4017 by numeric value. For example, @samp{1023M} sorts before @samp{1G}
4018 because @samp{M} (mega) precedes @samp{G} (giga) as an @acronym{SI}
4019 suffix. This option sorts values that are consistently scaled to the
4020 nearest suffix, regardless of whether suffixes denote powers of 1000
4021 or 1024, and it therefore sorts the output of any single invocation of
4022 the @command{df}, @command{du}, or @command{ls} commands that are
4023 invoked with their @option{--human-readable} or @option{--si} options.
4024 The syntax for numbers is the same as for the @option{--numeric-sort}
4025 option; the @acronym{SI} suffix must immediately follow the number.
4028 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
4030 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
4031 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
4032 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
4034 Ignore nonprinting characters.
4035 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4036 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
4037 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
4043 @opindex --month-sort
4045 @cindex months, sorting by
4047 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
4048 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
4049 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}.
4050 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
4051 category determines the month spellings.
4052 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4056 @itemx --numeric-sort
4057 @itemx --sort=numeric
4059 @opindex --numeric-sort
4061 @cindex numeric sort
4063 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
4064 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
4065 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
4066 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
4067 number is treated as @samp{0}. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
4068 locale specifies the decimal-point character and thousands separator.
4069 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4072 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
4074 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
4075 To compare such strings numerically, use the
4076 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
4079 @itemx --version-sort
4081 @opindex --version-sort
4082 @cindex version number sort
4083 Sort by version name and number. It behaves like a standard sort,
4084 except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
4085 as an index/version number. (@xref{Details about version sort}.)
4091 @cindex reverse sorting
4092 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
4093 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
4096 @itemx --random-sort
4097 @itemx --sort=random
4099 @opindex --random-sort
4102 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
4103 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
4104 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
4105 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
4106 except that keys with the same value sort together.
4108 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
4109 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
4110 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
4113 The choice of hash function is affected by the
4114 @option{--random-source} option.
4122 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
4123 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
4125 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
4126 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
4127 standard input to standard output.
4129 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
4131 White space and the backslash character should not appear in
4132 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
4134 @filesZeroFromOption{sort,,sorted output}
4136 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4137 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4141 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
4142 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
4143 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
4145 Each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
4146 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
4147 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
4148 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
4149 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
4150 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
4151 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
4152 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
4153 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
4156 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
4157 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more notes on keys and more examples.
4158 See also the @option{--debug} option to help determine the part
4159 of the line being used in the sort.
4162 Highlight the portion of each line used for sorting.
4163 Also issue warnings about questionable usage to stderr.
4165 @item --batch-size=@var{nmerge}
4166 @opindex --batch-size
4167 @cindex number of inputs to merge, nmerge
4168 Merge at most @var{nmerge} inputs at once.
4170 When @command{sort} has to merge more than @var{nmerge} inputs,
4171 it merges them in groups of @var{nmerge}, saving the result in
4172 a temporary file, which is then used as an input in a subsequent merge.
4174 A large value of @var{nmerge} may improve merge performance and decrease
4175 temporary storage utilization at the expense of increased memory usage
4176 and I/O. Conversely a small value of @var{nmerge} may reduce memory
4177 requirements and I/O at the expense of temporary storage consumption and
4180 The value of @var{nmerge} must be at least 2. The default value is
4181 currently 16, but this is implementation-dependent and may change in
4184 The value of @var{nmerge} may be bounded by a resource limit for open
4185 file descriptors. The commands @samp{ulimit -n} or @samp{getconf
4186 OPEN_MAX} may display limits for your systems; these limits may be
4187 modified further if your program already has some files open, or if
4188 the operating system has other limits on the number of open files. If
4189 the value of @var{nmerge} exceeds the resource limit, @command{sort}
4190 silently uses a smaller value.
4192 @item -o @var{output-file}
4193 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4196 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4197 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4198 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
4199 @var{output-file}, so you can safely sort a file in place by using
4200 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}.
4201 However, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
4202 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
4203 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
4204 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
4206 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4207 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
4208 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}. Portable
4209 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
4212 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4213 @opindex --random-source
4214 @cindex random source for sorting
4215 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4216 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
4223 @cindex sort stability
4224 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4226 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
4227 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
4228 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
4231 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
4233 @opindex --buffer-size
4234 @cindex size for main memory sorting
4235 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
4236 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
4237 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
4238 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
4239 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
4240 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}. Appending
4241 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
4244 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
4245 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
4246 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
4247 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
4250 @item -t @var{separator}
4251 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
4253 @opindex --field-separator
4254 @cindex field separator character
4255 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
4256 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
4257 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
4258 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4261 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
4262 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
4263 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
4264 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
4265 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
4266 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
4267 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
4268 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
4270 To specify @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} as the field separator,
4271 use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g., @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
4273 @item -T @var{tempdir}
4274 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
4276 @opindex --temporary-directory
4277 @cindex temporary directory
4279 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
4280 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
4281 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
4282 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
4283 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
4284 disks and controllers.
4286 @item --parallel=@var{n}
4288 @cindex multithreaded sort
4289 Set the number of sorts run in parallel to @var{n}. By default,
4290 @var{n} is set to the number of available processors, but limited
4291 to 8, as there are diminishing performance gains after that.
4292 Note also that using @var{n} threads increases the memory usage by
4293 a factor of log @var{n}. Also see @ref{nproc invocation}.
4299 @cindex uniquifying output
4301 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
4302 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
4303 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
4305 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
4307 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
4308 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
4309 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
4310 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
4311 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
4313 @macro zeroTerminatedOption
4315 @itemx --zero-terminated
4317 @opindex --zero-terminated
4318 @cindex process zero-terminated items
4319 Delimit items with a zero byte rather than a newline (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf}).
4320 I.E. treat input as items separated by @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}
4321 and terminate output items with @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}.
4322 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
4323 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
4324 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
4325 or other special characters).
4327 @zeroTerminatedOption
4331 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
4332 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
4333 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}.
4334 @sc{gnu} sort follows the @acronym{POSIX}
4335 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
4336 According to @acronym{POSIX}, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
4337 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
4338 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
4339 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
4341 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
4342 of the option letters @samp{MbdfghinRrV} appended to it, in which case no
4343 global ordering options are inherited by that particular field. The
4344 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
4345 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
4346 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
4347 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
4348 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b} or
4349 an option that implicitly ignores leading blanks (@samp{Mghn}) as otherwise
4350 the varying numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
4352 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
4353 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
4354 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
4355 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
4357 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4358 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4359 On older systems, @command{sort} supports an obsolete origin-zero
4360 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
4361 The obsolete sequence @samp{sort +@var{a}.@var{x} -@var{b}.@var{y}}
4362 is equivalent to @samp{sort -k @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b}} if @var{y}
4363 is @samp{0} or absent, otherwise it is equivalent to @samp{sort -k
4364 @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b+1}.@var{y}}.
4366 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
4367 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4368 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
4369 not set by using the obsolete syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
4371 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
4372 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
4373 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
4374 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
4375 support only the obsolete syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
4376 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
4379 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
4384 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
4391 Run no more than 4 sorts concurrently, using a buffer size of 10M.
4394 sort --parallel=4 -S 10M
4398 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
4399 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
4400 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
4401 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
4402 and extending to the end of each line.
4409 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
4410 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
4411 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
4414 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
4417 Note that if you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
4418 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
4419 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
4420 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
4421 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
4423 Also note that the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
4424 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
4425 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
4426 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
4427 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
4428 field-end part of the key specifier.
4431 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
4432 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
4433 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
4437 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4438 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
4439 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4442 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
4443 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
4444 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
4445 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
4446 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
4447 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
4448 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
4452 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
4453 time stamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
4454 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
4455 files contain lines that look like this:
4458 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2004:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
4459 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2004:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
4462 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
4463 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
4464 because 61 is less than 129.
4467 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
4468 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
4471 This example cannot be done with a single @command{sort} invocation,
4472 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
4473 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
4474 @command{sort}: the first sorts by time stamp and the second by IPv4
4475 address. The time stamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
4476 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
4477 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
4478 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
4479 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
4480 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
4481 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
4482 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
4486 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
4489 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
4492 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
4493 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
4495 by the sort operation.
4497 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
4499 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
4500 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0}, then using sort's -z option,
4501 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
4504 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n' |
4505 @c perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g' |
4507 @c perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
4511 Use the common @acronym{DSU, Decorate Sort Undecorate} idiom to
4512 sort lines according to their length.
4515 awk '@{print length, $0@}' /etc/passwd | sort -n | cut -f2- -d' '
4518 In general this technique can be used to sort data that the @command{sort}
4519 command does not support, or is inefficient at, sorting directly.
4522 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
4523 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
4524 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
4528 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
4534 @node shuf invocation
4535 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
4538 @cindex shuffling files
4540 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
4541 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
4545 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
4546 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
4547 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
4550 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
4551 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
4552 input. The following options change the operation mode:
4560 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
4561 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
4563 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
4564 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
4566 @opindex --input-range
4567 @cindex input range to shuffle
4568 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
4569 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
4573 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
4578 @item -n @var{lines}
4579 @itemx --head-count=@var{count}
4581 @opindex --head-count
4582 @cindex head of output
4583 Output at most @var{count} lines. By default, all input lines are
4586 @item -o @var{output-file}
4587 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4590 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4591 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4592 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
4593 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
4594 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
4596 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4597 @opindex --random-source
4598 @cindex random source for shuffling
4599 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4600 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
4602 @zeroTerminatedOption
4618 might produce the output
4628 Similarly, the command:
4631 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
4645 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
4655 These examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
4656 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
4657 general, if there are @var{n} input lines, there are @var{n}! (i.e.,
4658 @var{n} factorial, or @var{n} * (@var{n} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
4659 output permutations.
4664 @node uniq invocation
4665 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
4668 @cindex uniquify files
4670 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
4671 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
4675 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4678 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
4679 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
4680 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
4681 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
4683 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
4684 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
4685 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
4686 @xref{sort invocation}.
4689 Comparisons honor the rules specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE}
4692 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
4695 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4700 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
4702 @opindex --skip-fields
4703 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
4704 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields. Fields
4705 are sequences of non-space non-tab characters that are separated from
4706 each other by at least one space or tab.
4708 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4709 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
4712 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
4714 @opindex --skip-chars
4715 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
4716 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
4717 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
4719 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4720 On older systems, @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4722 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
4723 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4724 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
4725 behavior depends on this variable.
4726 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
4727 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
4733 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
4736 @itemx --ignore-case
4738 @opindex --ignore-case
4739 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
4745 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
4746 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
4747 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
4751 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
4753 @opindex --all-repeated
4754 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
4755 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
4756 but discard lines that are not repeated.
4757 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
4758 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
4759 The optional @var{delimit-method} tells how to delimit
4760 groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the following:
4765 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
4766 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
4769 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
4770 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use a zero
4771 byte (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a newline.
4774 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
4775 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use a zero
4776 byte (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a newline.
4777 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
4778 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
4779 may be better suited for output direct to users.
4782 Note that when groups are delimited and the input stream contains
4783 two or more consecutive blank lines, then the output is ambiguous.
4784 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\n'} to replace
4785 each sequence of consecutive newlines with a single newline.
4787 This is a @sc{gnu} extension.
4788 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
4794 @cindex unique lines, outputting
4795 Discard the first repeated line. When used by itself, this option
4796 causes @command{uniq} to print unique lines, and nothing else.
4799 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
4801 @opindex --check-chars
4802 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
4803 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
4806 @zeroTerminatedOption
4813 @node comm invocation
4814 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
4817 @cindex line-by-line comparison
4818 @cindex comparing sorted files
4820 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
4821 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
4822 standard input. Synopsis:
4825 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
4829 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
4830 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
4831 If an input file ends in a non-newline
4832 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
4833 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
4835 @cindex differing lines
4836 @cindex common lines
4837 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
4838 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
4839 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
4840 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
4841 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
4842 @c string, append "by default" to the above sentence.
4847 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
4848 the corresponding columns (and separators). Also see @ref{Common options}.
4850 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
4851 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
4852 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
4853 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
4855 @macro checkOrderOption{cmd}
4856 If the @option{--check-order} option is given, unsorted inputs will
4857 cause a fatal error message. If the option @option{--nocheck-order}
4858 is given, unsorted inputs will never cause an error message. If neither
4859 of these options is given, wrongly sorted inputs are diagnosed
4860 only if an input file is found to contain unpairable
4862 lines, and when both input files are non empty.
4864 @ifclear JOIN_COMMAND
4867 If an input file is diagnosed as being unsorted, the @command{\cmd\}
4868 command will exit with a nonzero status (and the output should not be used).
4870 Forcing @command{\cmd\} to process wrongly sorted input files
4871 containing unpairable lines by specifying @option{--nocheck-order} is
4872 not guaranteed to produce any particular output. The output will
4873 probably not correspond with whatever you hoped it would be.
4875 @checkOrderOption{comm}
4880 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
4882 @item --nocheck-order
4883 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order.
4887 @item --output-delimiter=@var{str}
4888 Print @var{str} between adjacent output columns,
4889 rather than the default of a single TAB character.
4891 The delimiter @var{str} may not be empty.
4895 @node ptx invocation
4896 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
4900 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
4901 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
4904 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
4905 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4908 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
4909 all @sc{gnu} extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
4910 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
4911 When @option{-G} is not specified, @sc{gnu} extensions are always enabled.
4912 @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
4913 document. @xref{Compatibility in ptx}, for the full list.
4915 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
4917 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
4918 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
4919 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
4920 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
4921 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
4922 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
4923 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
4924 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
4927 When @sc{gnu} extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
4928 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
4929 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
4930 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
4931 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
4932 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
4933 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
4934 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful} to note that,
4935 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
4936 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
4937 compatibility; @sc{gnu} Standards normally discourage output parameters not
4938 introduced by an option.
4940 Note that for @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
4941 input text file, a single dash @kbd{-} may be used, in which case
4942 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
4943 convention more than once per program invocation.
4946 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
4947 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
4948 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
4949 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
4950 * Compatibility in ptx::
4954 @node General options in ptx
4955 @subsection General options
4960 @itemx --traditional
4961 As already explained, this option disables all @sc{gnu} extensions to
4962 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
4965 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
4969 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
4977 @node Charset selection in ptx
4978 @subsection Charset selection
4980 @c FIXME: People don't necessarily know what an IBM-PC was these days.
4981 As it is set up now, the program assumes that the input file is coded
4982 using 8-bit @acronym{ISO} 8859-1 code, also known as Latin-1 character set,
4983 @emph{unless} it is compiled for MS-DOS, in which case it uses the
4984 character set of the IBM-PC@. (@sc{gnu} @command{ptx} is not known to work on
4985 smaller MS-DOS machines anymore.) Compared to 7-bit @acronym{ASCII}, the set
4986 of characters which are letters is different; this alters the behavior
4987 of regular expression matching. Thus, the default regular expression
4988 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
4989 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
4995 @itemx --ignore-case
4996 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
5001 @node Input processing in ptx
5002 @subsection Word selection and input processing
5007 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
5009 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
5010 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
5011 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
5012 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
5013 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
5014 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
5015 @option{-b} is ignored.
5017 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
5018 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
5019 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When @sc{gnu} extensions
5020 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
5021 characters even if not included in the Break file.
5024 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
5026 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5027 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
5028 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
5029 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
5033 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
5035 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5036 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
5037 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
5038 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
5039 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
5041 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
5042 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
5043 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
5048 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
5049 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
5050 line in the resulting permuted index.
5051 @xref{Output formatting in ptx},
5052 for more information about reference production.
5053 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
5055 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
5056 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
5057 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
5058 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when @sc{gnu} extensions
5059 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
5060 excluded from the output contexts.
5062 @item -S @var{regexp}
5063 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
5065 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
5066 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
5067 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
5068 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
5069 default, when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
5070 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
5071 imported from @sc{gnu} Emacs:
5074 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
5077 Whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
5078 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
5084 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
5085 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
5086 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
5087 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
5088 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5091 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
5092 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
5093 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
5094 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
5095 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
5096 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
5097 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
5098 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
5099 on the right of the output line.
5101 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5102 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
5103 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5105 @item -W @var{regexp}
5106 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
5108 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
5109 By default, if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
5110 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When @sc{gnu} extensions are
5111 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
5112 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
5114 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
5115 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5118 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5119 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5120 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5125 @node Output formatting in ptx
5126 @subsection Output formatting
5128 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
5129 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
5130 selected, and if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
5131 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
5132 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
5133 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
5134 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
5135 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
5136 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
5137 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with @sc{gnu}
5138 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
5139 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
5140 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
5141 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
5142 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
5143 characters is transmitted verbatim.
5145 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
5149 @item -g @var{number}
5150 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
5152 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
5155 @item -w @var{number}
5156 @itemx --width=@var{number}
5158 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
5159 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
5160 depending on the value of option @option{-R}. If this option is not
5161 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
5162 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
5163 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
5164 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
5165 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
5169 @itemx --auto-reference
5171 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
5172 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
5173 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
5174 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
5175 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
5176 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
5179 @itemx --right-side-refs
5181 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
5182 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
5183 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
5184 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
5185 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
5186 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
5187 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
5188 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
5190 This option is automatically selected whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are
5193 @item -F @var{string}
5194 @itemx --flac-truncation=@var{string}
5196 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
5197 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
5198 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
5199 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}. But there is a maximum
5200 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
5201 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
5202 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
5203 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
5204 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
5206 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F ...}.
5207 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
5208 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
5211 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5212 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5213 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5215 @item -M @var{string}
5216 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
5218 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
5219 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
5222 @itemx --format=roff
5224 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
5225 processing. Each output line will look like:
5228 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}"@c
5229 "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
5232 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
5233 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when @sc{gnu}
5234 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
5235 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
5237 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
5238 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
5239 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character: @kbd{"} is doubled
5240 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
5245 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
5246 line will look like:
5249 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@c
5250 @{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
5254 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
5255 the output typesetting. Note that when references are not being
5256 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
5257 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
5258 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
5261 In this output format, some special characters, like @kbd{$}, @kbd{%},
5262 @kbd{&}, @kbd{#} and @kbd{_} are automatically protected with a
5263 backslash. Curly brackets @kbd{@{}, @kbd{@}} are protected with a
5264 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
5265 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
5266 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
5267 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
5268 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
5269 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
5270 and all other characters which are not part of @acronym{ASCII}, are merely
5271 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
5272 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
5273 processing for @TeX{}.
5278 @node Compatibility in ptx
5279 @subsection The @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx}
5281 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
5282 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
5283 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
5284 options. Some @sc{gnu} extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
5285 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about @sc{gnu} extensions.
5286 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
5291 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
5292 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
5293 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
5294 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
5297 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
5298 practice which @sc{gnu} avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
5299 portably between @sc{gnu} and System V, you should always use it with a
5300 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
5301 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
5302 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
5303 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
5306 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
5307 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
5308 @option{-w}. All other options are @sc{gnu} extensions and are not repeated in
5309 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
5310 meaning when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, as explained below.
5313 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
5314 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
5315 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
5318 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
5319 subtracted from the total output line width. With @sc{gnu} extensions
5320 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
5321 line width computations.
5324 All 256 bytes, even @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} bytes, are always read and
5325 processed from input file with no adverse effect, even if @sc{gnu} extensions
5326 are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit characters,
5327 a few control characters are rejected, and the tilde @kbd{~} is also rejected.
5330 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if @sc{gnu}
5331 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
5332 the first 200 characters in each line.
5335 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
5336 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When @sc{gnu}
5337 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
5341 The program makes better use of output line width. If @sc{gnu} extensions
5342 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
5343 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
5344 not completely reproduce.
5347 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
5348 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
5353 @node tsort invocation
5354 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
5357 @cindex topological sort
5359 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
5360 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
5361 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
5365 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
5368 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
5369 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
5370 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
5384 will produce the output
5395 Consider a more realistic example.
5396 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
5397 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
5398 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
5399 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
5400 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
5401 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
5402 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
5403 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
5404 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
5405 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
5406 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
5407 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
5413 tail_file pretty_name
5414 tail_file write_header
5416 tail_forever recheck
5417 tail_forever pretty_name
5418 tail_forever write_header
5419 tail_forever dump_remainder
5422 tail_lines start_lines
5423 tail_lines dump_remainder
5424 tail_lines file_lines
5425 tail_lines pipe_lines
5427 tail_bytes start_bytes
5428 tail_bytes dump_remainder
5429 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
5430 file_lines dump_remainder
5434 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
5435 functions that satisfies your requirement.
5438 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
5458 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
5459 encountered to standard error.
5461 Note that for a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
5462 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
5463 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
5464 precedes @code{main}.
5466 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
5472 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
5475 @node tsort background
5476 @subsection @command{tsort}: Background
5478 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
5479 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
5480 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
5481 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
5484 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
5485 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
5486 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
5487 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
5488 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
5489 reference to @code{read}.
5491 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
5492 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
5493 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
5494 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
5497 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
5498 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
5500 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
5501 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
5502 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
5503 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
5506 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
5507 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
5511 @node Operating on fields
5512 @chapter Operating on fields
5515 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
5516 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
5517 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
5521 @node cut invocation
5522 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
5525 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
5526 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
5530 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5533 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
5534 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
5535 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
5536 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
5537 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
5538 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
5539 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
5540 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
5541 is written exactly once.
5543 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
5548 @item -b @var{byte-list}
5549 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
5552 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
5553 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
5554 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
5555 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
5556 string between ranges of selected bytes.
5558 @item -c @var{character-list}
5559 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
5561 @opindex --characters
5562 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
5563 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
5564 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
5565 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
5566 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
5567 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
5570 @item -f @var{field-list}
5571 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
5574 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
5575 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
5576 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
5577 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified.
5579 Note @command{awk} supports more sophisticated field processing,
5580 and by default will use (and discard) runs of blank characters to
5581 separate fields, and ignore leading and trailing blanks.
5584 awk '{print $2}' # print the second field
5585 awk '{print $NF-1}' # print the penultimate field
5586 awk '{print $2,$1}' # reorder the first two fields
5590 In the unlikely event that @command{awk} is unavailable,
5591 one can use the @command{join} command, to process blank
5592 characters as @command{awk} does above.
5595 join -a1 -o 1.2 - /dev/null # print the second field
5596 join -a1 -o 1.2,1.1 - /dev/null # reorder the first two fields
5600 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
5601 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
5603 @opindex --delimiter
5604 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
5605 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
5609 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
5612 @itemx --only-delimited
5614 @opindex --only-delimited
5615 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
5616 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
5618 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
5619 @opindex --output-delimiter
5620 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
5621 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
5622 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
5623 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
5624 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
5625 ranges of selected bytes.
5628 @opindex --complement
5629 This option is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
5630 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
5631 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
5632 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
5633 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
5634 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
5641 @node paste invocation
5642 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
5645 @cindex merging files
5647 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
5648 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
5649 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
5671 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5674 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5682 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
5683 file. Using the above example data:
5686 $ paste -s num2 let3
5691 @item -d @var{delim-list}
5692 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
5694 @opindex --delimiters
5695 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
5696 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
5697 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
5700 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
5711 @node join invocation
5712 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
5715 @cindex common field, joining on
5717 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
5718 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
5721 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5724 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
5725 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
5726 sorted on the join fields.
5729 Normally, the sort order is that of the
5730 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
5731 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
5732 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
5733 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
5734 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}.
5736 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
5737 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
5738 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
5739 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
5740 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
5741 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
5742 If @samp{join -t ''} is specified then the whole line is considered which
5743 matches the default operation of sort.
5745 If the input has no unpairable lines, a @acronym{GNU} extension is
5746 available; the sort order can be any order that considers two fields
5747 to be equal if and only if the sort comparison described above
5748 considers them to be equal. For example:
5766 @checkOrderOption{join}
5771 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
5772 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
5773 blanks on the line ignored;
5774 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
5775 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
5776 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
5779 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5783 @item -a @var{file-number}
5785 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
5786 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
5789 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
5791 @item --nocheck-order
5792 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order. This is the default.
5794 @item -e @var{string}
5796 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with @var{string}.
5797 I.E. missing fields specified with the @option{-12jo} options.
5801 Treat the first line of each input file as a header line. The header lines will
5802 be joined and printed as the first output line. If @option{-o} is used to
5803 specify output format, the header line will be printed according to the
5804 specified format. The header lines will not be checked for ordering even if
5805 @option{--check-order} is specified. Also if the header lines from each file
5806 do not match, the heading fields from the first file will be used.
5809 @itemx --ignore-case
5811 @opindex --ignore-case
5812 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
5813 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
5814 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
5816 @item -1 @var{field}
5818 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
5820 @item -2 @var{field}
5822 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
5824 @item -j @var{field}
5825 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
5827 @item -o @var{field-list}
5829 If the keyword @samp{auto} is specified, infer the output format from
5830 the first line in each file. This is the same as the default output format
5831 but also ensures the same number of fields are output for each line.
5832 Missing fields are replaced with the @option{-e} option and extra fields
5835 Otherwise, construct each output line according to the format in
5836 @var{field-list}. Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single
5837 character @samp{0} or has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m},
5838 is @samp{1} or @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
5840 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
5841 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
5842 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
5843 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
5844 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
5845 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
5846 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
5847 To give @command{join} that functionality, @acronym{POSIX} invented the @samp{0}
5848 field specification notation.
5850 The elements in @var{field-list}
5851 are separated by commas or blanks.
5852 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
5853 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
5854 2.2'} are equivalent.
5856 All output lines---including those printed because of any -a or -v
5857 option---are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
5860 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
5861 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
5862 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
5863 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering. If @samp{join -t ''} is specified,
5864 the whole line is considered, matching the default operation of sort.
5865 If @samp{-t '\0'} is specified then the @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}
5866 character is used to delimit the fields.
5868 @item -v @var{file-number}
5869 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
5870 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
5877 @node Operating on characters
5878 @chapter Operating on characters
5880 @cindex operating on characters
5882 This commands operate on individual characters.
5885 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
5886 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
5887 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
5892 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
5899 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{set1} [@var{set2}]
5902 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
5903 one of the following operations:
5907 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
5909 squeeze repeated characters,
5913 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
5916 The @var{set1} and (if given) @var{set2} arguments define ordered
5917 sets of characters, referred to below as @var{set1} and @var{set2}. These
5918 sets are the characters of the input that @command{tr} operates on.
5919 The @option{--complement} (@option{-c}, @option{-C}) option replaces
5921 complement (all of the characters that are not in @var{set1}).
5923 Currently @command{tr} fully supports only single-byte characters.
5924 Eventually it will support multibyte characters; when it does, the
5925 @option{-C} option will cause it to complement the set of characters,
5926 whereas @option{-c} will cause it to complement the set of values.
5927 This distinction will matter only when some values are not characters,
5928 and this is possible only in locales using multibyte encodings when
5929 the input contains encoding errors.
5931 The program accepts the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
5932 options. @xref{Common options}. Options must precede operands.
5937 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
5938 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
5939 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
5943 @node Character sets
5944 @subsection Specifying sets of characters
5946 @cindex specifying sets of characters
5948 The format of the @var{set1} and @var{set2} arguments resembles
5949 the format of regular expressions; however, they are not regular
5950 expressions, only lists of characters. Most characters simply
5951 represent themselves in these strings, but the strings can contain
5952 the shorthands listed below, for convenience. Some of them can be
5953 used only in @var{set1} or @var{set2}, as noted below.
5957 @item Backslash escapes
5958 @cindex backslash escapes
5960 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
5978 The 8-bit character with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is 1 to 3
5979 octal digits. Note that @samp{\400} is interpreted as the two-byte
5980 sequence, @samp{\040} @samp{0}.
5985 While a backslash followed by a character not listed above is
5986 interpreted as that character, the backslash also effectively
5987 removes any special significance, so it is useful to escape
5988 @samp{[}, @samp{]}, @samp{*}, and @samp{-}.
5993 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to all of the characters
5994 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
5995 collate before @var{n}; if it doesn't, an error results. As an example,
5996 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
5998 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
5999 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
6000 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
6001 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
6002 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
6005 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not
6006 portable. For example, on @acronym{EBCDIC} hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
6007 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
6008 are not contiguous as they are in @acronym{ASCII}.
6009 If you can rely on a @acronym{POSIX} compliant version of @command{tr}, then
6010 the best way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
6011 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
6014 @item Repeated characters
6015 @cindex repeated characters
6017 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{set2} expands to @var{n}
6018 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
6019 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
6020 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{set2} as long as
6021 @var{set1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
6022 octal, otherwise in decimal.
6024 @item Character classes
6025 @cindex character classes
6027 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all of the characters in
6028 the (predefined) class @var{class}. The characters expand in no
6029 particular order, except for the @code{upper} and @code{lower} classes,
6030 which expand in ascending order. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
6031 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
6032 character class can be used in @var{set2}. Otherwise, only the
6033 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
6034 @var{set2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
6035 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
6036 relative position in @var{set1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
6037 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
6049 Horizontal whitespace.
6058 Printable characters, not including space.
6064 Printable characters, including space.
6067 Punctuation characters.
6070 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
6079 @item Equivalence classes
6080 @cindex equivalence classes
6082 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all of the characters that are
6083 equivalent to @var{c}, in no particular order. Equivalence classes are
6084 a relatively recent invention intended to support non-English alphabets.
6085 But there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
6086 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in @sc{gnu} @command{tr};
6087 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
6088 which is of no particular use.
6094 @subsection Translating
6096 @cindex translating characters
6098 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{set1} and @var{set2} are
6099 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
6100 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{set1}
6101 to the corresponding character in @var{set2}. Characters not in
6102 @var{set1} are passed through unchanged. When a character appears more
6103 than once in @var{set1} and the corresponding characters in @var{set2}
6104 are not all the same, only the final one is used. For example, these
6105 two commands are equivalent:
6112 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
6113 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
6116 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
6118 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
6122 But note that using ranges like @code{a-z} above is not portable.
6124 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{set1} and @var{set2}
6125 typically have the same length. If @var{set1} is shorter than
6126 @var{set2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{set2} are ignored.
6128 On the other hand, making @var{set1} longer than @var{set2} is not
6129 portable; @acronym{POSIX} says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
6130 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{set2} to the length of @var{set1} by repeating
6131 the last character of @var{set2} as many times as necessary. System V
6132 @command{tr} truncates @var{set1} to the length of @var{set2}.
6134 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
6135 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
6136 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
6137 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
6139 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
6143 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
6147 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
6148 complement of @var{set1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
6152 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
6153 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012.
6154 Assuming a @acronym{POSIX} compliant @command{tr}, here is a better
6158 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
6163 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
6165 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
6166 @cindex deleting characters
6168 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
6169 removes any input characters that are in @var{set1}.
6171 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option,
6172 @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a repeated character that
6173 is in @var{set1} with a single occurrence of that character.
6175 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
6176 first performs any deletions using @var{set1}, then squeezes repeats
6177 from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
6179 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
6180 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
6181 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
6183 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
6188 Remove all zero bytes:
6195 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
6196 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
6197 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
6200 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
6204 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline:
6211 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
6212 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
6213 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
6214 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
6215 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
6216 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
6217 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
6218 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
6224 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
6225 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
6230 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
6231 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
6237 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
6238 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
6239 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
6240 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
6241 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
6242 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
6243 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
6244 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
6245 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
6252 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
6258 More generally, use the character class notation @code{[=c=]}
6259 with @samp{-} (or any other character) in place of the @samp{c}:
6265 Note how single quotes are used in the above example to protect the
6266 square brackets from interpretation by a shell.
6271 @node expand invocation
6272 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
6275 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
6276 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
6278 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
6279 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
6280 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
6284 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6287 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
6288 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
6289 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
6290 tabs every 8 columns).
6292 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6296 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6297 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6300 @cindex tab stops, setting
6301 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
6302 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
6303 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
6304 last tab stop given with single spaces. Tab stops can be separated by
6305 blanks as well as by commas.
6307 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
6308 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
6309 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
6315 @cindex initial tabs, converting
6316 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
6317 characters) on each line to spaces.
6324 @node unexpand invocation
6325 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
6329 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
6330 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
6331 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
6332 as many tab characters as needed. In the default @acronym{POSIX}
6333 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
6334 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
6337 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6340 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
6341 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
6342 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
6343 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
6346 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6350 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6351 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6354 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
6355 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
6356 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
6357 beyond the tab stops given unchanged. Tab stops can be separated by
6358 blanks as well as by commas. This option implies the @option{-a} option.
6360 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
6361 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
6362 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
6363 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
6364 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
6370 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
6371 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
6378 @node Directory listing
6379 @chapter Directory listing
6381 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
6382 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
6385 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
6386 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
6387 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
6388 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
6393 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
6396 @cindex directory listing
6398 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
6399 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
6400 arbitrarily, as usual.
6402 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
6403 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
6404 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
6405 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
6406 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
6407 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
6410 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
6411 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-@acronym{POSIX}
6412 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
6413 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
6414 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
6415 If standard output is
6416 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
6417 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
6418 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
6420 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
6421 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
6422 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
6423 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
6424 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
6426 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
6431 1 minor problems (e.g., failure to access a file or directory not
6432 specified as a command line argument. This happens when listing a
6433 directory in which entries are actively being removed or renamed.)
6434 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted, invalid option, failure
6435 to access a file or directory specified as a command line argument
6436 or a directory loop)
6439 Also see @ref{Common options}.
6442 * Which files are listed::
6443 * What information is listed::
6444 * Sorting the output::
6445 * Details about version sort::
6446 * General output formatting::
6447 * Formatting file timestamps::
6448 * Formatting the file names::
6452 @node Which files are listed
6453 @subsection Which files are listed
6455 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
6456 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
6457 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
6458 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
6466 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
6471 @opindex --almost-all
6472 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
6473 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
6474 option overrides this option.
6477 @itemx --ignore-backups
6479 @opindex --ignore-backups
6480 @cindex backup files, ignoring
6481 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
6482 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
6487 @opindex --directory
6488 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
6489 than listing their contents.
6490 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
6491 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
6492 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
6493 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6494 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
6497 @itemx --dereference-command-line
6499 @opindex --dereference-command-line
6500 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6501 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
6502 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
6504 @itemx --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6505 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6506 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6507 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
6508 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
6509 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
6511 This is the default behavior when no other dereferencing-related
6512 option has been specified (@option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
6513 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
6515 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6516 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
6518 @item --group-directories-first
6519 @opindex --group-directories-first
6520 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
6521 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
6522 (see --sort option).
6523 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
6524 and the --sort option specifies a secondary key.
6525 However, any use of @option{--sort=none}
6526 (@option{-U}) disables this option altogether.
6528 @item --hide=PATTERN
6529 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
6530 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6531 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
6532 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
6533 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
6534 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
6535 (@option{-A}) is also given.
6537 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
6538 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
6539 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
6540 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
6542 @item -I @var{pattern}
6543 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
6545 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
6546 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6547 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
6548 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
6549 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
6550 to give this option several times. For example,
6553 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
6556 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
6557 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
6558 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
6561 @itemx --dereference
6563 @opindex --dereference
6564 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6565 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
6566 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
6567 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
6568 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
6573 @opindex --recursive
6574 @cindex recursive directory listing
6575 @cindex directory listing, recursive
6576 List the contents of all directories recursively.
6581 @node What information is listed
6582 @subsection What information is listed
6584 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
6585 default, only file names are shown.
6591 @cindex hurd, author, printing
6592 List each file's author when producing long format directory listings.
6593 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
6594 operating systems the two are the same.
6600 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
6601 With the long listing (@option{-l}) format, print an additional line after
6605 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
6609 The @var{begn} and @var{endn} are unsigned integers that record the
6610 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
6611 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
6612 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
6614 If directories are being listed recursively (@option{-R}), output a similar
6615 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
6618 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
6621 Finally, output a line of the form:
6624 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
6628 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
6630 Here is an actual example:
6633 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
6635 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
6636 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
6639 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
6640 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
6641 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
6642 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
6646 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
6650 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
6654 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
6655 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
6656 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
6659 Note that the pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
6660 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
6662 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
6663 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
6665 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
6666 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
6669 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
6670 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
6674 Note that although the listing above includes a trailing slash
6675 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
6676 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
6677 along with an option like @option{--escape} (aka @option{-b}) and operate
6678 on a file whose name contains special characters, notice that the backslash
6683 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
6684 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
6686 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
6689 If you use a quoting style that adds quote marks
6690 (e.g., @option{--quoting-style=c}), then the offsets include the quote marks.
6691 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
6692 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
6693 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal} option
6694 (aka @option{-N} or @option{--literal}) on the command line, or else be
6695 prepared to parse the escaped names.
6698 @opindex --full-time
6699 Produce long format directory listings, and list times in full. It is
6700 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with
6701 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
6705 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display owner information.
6711 Inhibit display of group information in a long format directory listing.
6712 (This is the default in some non-@sc{gnu} versions of @command{ls}, so we
6713 provide this option for compatibility.)
6721 @cindex inode number, printing
6722 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
6723 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
6724 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
6727 @itemx --format=long
6728 @itemx --format=verbose
6731 @opindex long ls @r{format}
6732 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
6733 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
6734 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
6735 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
6736 the modification time. Print question marks for information that
6737 cannot be determined.
6739 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
6740 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}). For example, @option{-h}
6741 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
6742 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
6743 separator of the current locale.
6745 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
6746 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the total disk allocation
6747 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
6748 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6749 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
6750 this is arguably a deficiency.
6752 The file type is one of the following characters:
6754 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
6762 character special file
6764 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
6768 door (Solaris 2.5 and up)
6770 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
6774 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
6776 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
6778 network special file (HP-UX)
6782 port (Solaris 10 and up)
6784 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
6788 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6790 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6792 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
6794 some other file type
6797 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
6798 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
6799 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
6800 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
6804 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
6808 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
6809 executable bit is not set.
6812 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
6813 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
6814 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
6817 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
6818 other-executable bit is not set.
6821 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
6827 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
6828 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
6829 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
6830 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
6831 character, then there is such a method.
6833 GNU @command{ls} uses a @samp{.} character to indicate a file
6834 with an SELinux security context, but no other alternate access method.
6836 A file with any other combination of alternate access methods
6837 is marked with a @samp{+} character.
6840 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
6842 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
6843 @cindex numeric uid and gid
6844 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
6845 Produce long format directory listings, but
6846 display numeric user and group IDs instead of the owner and group names.
6850 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display group information.
6851 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with @option{--no-group} .
6857 @cindex disk allocation
6858 @cindex size of files, reporting
6859 Print the disk allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
6860 This is the amount of disk space used by the file, which is usually a
6861 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
6863 Normally the disk allocation is printed in units of
6864 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6866 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
6867 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
6868 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
6869 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
6870 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
6871 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
6880 @cindex security context
6881 Display the SELinux security context or @samp{?} if none is found.
6882 When used with the @option{-l} option, print the security context
6883 to the left of the size column.
6888 @node Sorting the output
6889 @subsection Sorting the output
6891 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
6892 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
6893 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
6894 (e.g., @acronym{ASCII} order).
6900 @itemx --time=status
6903 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
6904 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
6905 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6906 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{-l}, @option{-o}) is being used,
6907 print the status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) instead of
6908 the modification time.
6909 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6910 or when not using a long listing format,
6911 sort according to the status change time.
6915 @cindex unsorted directory listing
6916 @cindex directory order, listing by
6917 Primarily, like @option{-U}---do not sort; list the files in whatever
6918 order they are stored in the directory. But also enable @option{-a} (list
6919 all files) and disable @option{-l}, @option{--color}, and @option{-s} (if they
6920 were specified before the @option{-f}).
6926 @cindex reverse sorting
6927 Reverse whatever the sorting method is---e.g., list files in reverse
6928 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
6934 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
6935 Sort by file size, largest first.
6941 @opindex modification time@r{, sorting files by}
6942 Sort by modification time (the @samp{mtime} in the inode), newest first.
6946 @itemx --time=access
6950 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6951 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6952 @opindex access time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6953 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{--format=long}) is being used,
6954 print the last access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode).
6955 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6956 or when not using a long listing format, sort according to the access time.
6962 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6963 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
6964 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
6965 that @option{-f} does.) This is especially useful when listing very large
6966 directories, since not doing any sorting can be noticeably faster.
6969 @itemx --sort=version
6972 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6973 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
6974 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
6975 as an index/version number. (@xref{Details about version sort}.)
6978 @itemx --sort=extension
6981 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
6982 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
6983 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
6988 @node Details about version sort
6989 @subsection Details about version sort
6991 Version sorting handles the fact that file names frequently include indices or
6992 version numbers. Standard sorting usually does not produce the order that one
6993 expects because comparisons are made on a character-by-character basis.
6994 Version sorting is especially useful when browsing directories that contain
6995 many files with indices/version numbers in their names:
6999 abc.zml-1.gz abc.zml-1.gz
7000 abc.zml-12.gz abc.zml-2.gz
7001 abc.zml-2.gz abc.zml-12.gz
7004 Version-sorted strings are compared such that if @var{ver1} and @var{ver2}
7005 are version numbers and @var{prefix} and @var{suffix} (@var{suffix} matching
7006 the regular expression @samp{(\.[A-Za-z~][A-Za-z0-9~]*)*}) are strings then
7007 @var{ver1} < @var{ver2} implies that the name composed of
7008 ``@var{prefix} @var{ver1} @var{suffix}'' sorts before
7009 ``@var{prefix} @var{ver2} @var{suffix}''.
7011 Note also that leading zeros of numeric parts are ignored:
7015 abc-1.007.tgz abc-1.01a.tgz
7016 abc-1.012b.tgz abc-1.007.tgz
7017 abc-1.01a.tgz abc-1.012b.tgz
7020 This functionality is implemented using gnulib's @code{filevercmp} function,
7021 which has some caveats worth noting.
7024 @item @env{LC_COLLATE} is ignored, which means @samp{ls -v} and @samp{sort -V}
7025 will sort non-numeric prefixes as if the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale category
7026 was set to @samp{C}.
7027 @item Some suffixes will not be matched by the regular
7028 expression mentioned above. Consequently these examples may
7029 not sort as you expect:
7037 abc-1.2.3.4.x86_64.rpm
7038 abc-1.2.3.x86_64.rpm
7042 @node General output formatting
7043 @subsection General output formatting
7045 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
7050 @itemx --format=single-column
7053 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
7054 List one file per line. This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
7055 output is not a terminal.
7058 @itemx --format=vertical
7061 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
7062 List files in columns, sorted vertically. This is the default for
7063 @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal. It is always the default
7064 for the @command{dir} program.
7065 @sc{gnu} @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
7066 possible in the fewest lines.
7068 @item --color [=@var{when}]
7070 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
7071 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types. @var{when}
7072 may be omitted, or one of:
7075 @vindex none @r{color option}
7076 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
7078 @vindex auto @r{color option}
7079 @cindex terminal, using color iff
7080 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
7082 @vindex always @r{color option}
7085 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
7086 @option{--color=always}.
7087 Piping a colorized listing through a pager like @command{more} or
7088 @command{less} usually produces unreadable results. However, using
7089 @code{more -f} does seem to work.
7092 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
7093 Note that using the @option{--color} option may incur a noticeable
7094 performance penalty when run in a directory with very many entries,
7095 because the default settings require that @command{ls} @code{stat} every
7096 single file it lists.
7097 However, if you would like most of the file-type coloring
7098 but can live without the other coloring options (e.g.,
7099 executable, orphan, sticky, other-writable, capability), use
7100 @command{dircolors} to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment variable like this,
7102 eval $(dircolors -p | perl -pe \
7103 's/^((CAP|S[ET]|O[TR]|M|E)\w+).*/$1 00/' | dircolors -)
7105 and on a @code{dirent.d_type}-capable file system, @command{ls}
7106 will perform only one @code{stat} call per command line argument.
7110 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
7113 @opindex --indicator-style
7114 @cindex file type and executables, marking
7115 @cindex executables and file type, marking
7116 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
7117 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
7118 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
7119 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
7120 and nothing for regular files.
7121 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
7122 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
7123 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
7124 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
7125 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
7128 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
7129 @opindex --file-type
7130 @opindex --indicator-style
7131 @cindex file type, marking
7132 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
7133 like @option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
7135 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
7136 @opindex --indicator-style
7137 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
7142 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
7144 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
7147 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
7148 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
7149 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
7151 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
7152 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{-F} or
7153 @option{--classify} option.
7159 @opindex --kibibytes
7160 Set the default block size to its normal value of 1024 bytes,
7161 overriding any contrary specification in environment variables
7162 (@pxref{Block size}). This option is in turn overridden by the
7163 @option{--block-size}, @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable}, and
7164 @option{--si} options.
7166 The @option{-k} or @option{--kibibytes} option affects the
7167 per-directory block count written by the @option{-l} and similar
7168 options, and the size written by the @option{-s} or @option{--size}
7169 option. It does not affect the file size written by @option{-l}.
7172 @itemx --format=commas
7175 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
7176 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
7177 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space).
7180 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
7182 @opindex --indicator-style
7183 @cindex file type, marking
7184 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
7187 @itemx --format=across
7188 @itemx --format=horizontal
7191 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
7192 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
7193 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
7196 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
7199 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
7200 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
7201 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
7203 @c FIXME: remove in 2009, if Apple Terminal has been fixed for long enough.
7204 Some terminal emulators (at least Apple Terminal 1.5 (133) from Mac OS X 10.4.8)
7205 do not properly align columns to the right of a TAB following a
7206 non-@acronym{ASCII} byte. If you use such a terminal emulator, use the
7207 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment to tell
7208 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
7211 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
7215 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
7216 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
7217 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
7223 @node Formatting file timestamps
7224 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
7226 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form, using
7227 a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} for non-recent timestamps, and a
7228 date-without-year and time like @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
7229 This format can change depending on the current locale as detailed below.
7232 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
7233 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
7234 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
7235 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
7236 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
7239 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
7240 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
7241 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
7242 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
7244 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
7247 @item --time-style=@var{style}
7248 @opindex --time-style
7250 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
7251 be one of the following:
7256 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
7257 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
7258 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
7259 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
7260 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
7261 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
7263 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
7264 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
7265 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
7266 spaces in one of the two formats.
7269 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
7270 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
7271 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
7272 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
7274 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
7275 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
7276 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since @acronym{GNU} @command{make}
7277 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
7280 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
7281 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
7282 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
7283 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
7286 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
7287 @samp{2002-03-30@ }), and @acronym{ISO} 8601 month, day, hour, and
7288 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
7289 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
7290 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
7291 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
7292 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
7297 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
7298 ls -l --time-style="iso"
7303 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a Finnish
7304 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30@ @ 2002}
7305 and recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30 23:45}. Locale-dependent
7306 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
7307 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
7308 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
7310 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
7311 default @acronym{POSIX} locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
7312 @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
7313 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
7318 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
7319 ls -l --time-style="locale"
7322 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
7323 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
7324 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
7325 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2002@ } and
7326 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
7328 @item posix-@var{style}
7330 List @acronym{POSIX}-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
7331 category is @acronym{POSIX}, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
7332 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
7333 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
7334 the @acronym{POSIX} locale, and like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
7339 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
7340 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
7341 the default style is @samp{locale}. @acronym{GNU} Emacs 21.3 and
7342 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
7343 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
7344 non-@acronym{POSIX} locale you may need to set
7345 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
7347 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
7348 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
7351 @node Formatting the file names
7352 @subsection Formatting the file names
7354 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
7360 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
7363 @opindex --quoting-style
7364 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
7365 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
7366 backslash sequences like those used in C.
7370 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
7373 @opindex --quoting-style
7374 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
7375 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
7376 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
7380 @itemx --hide-control-chars
7382 @opindex --hide-control-chars
7383 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
7384 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
7389 @itemx --quoting-style=c
7391 @opindex --quote-name
7392 @opindex --quoting-style
7393 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
7396 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
7397 @opindex --quoting-style
7398 @cindex quoting style
7399 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
7400 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
7401 be one of the following:
7405 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{-N} or
7406 @option{--literal} option.
7408 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
7409 cause ambiguous output.
7410 The quoting is suitable for @acronym{POSIX}-compatible shells like
7411 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
7414 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
7416 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
7417 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
7418 @option{-Q} or @option{--quote-name} option.
7420 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
7421 surrounding double-quote
7422 characters; this is the same as the @option{-b} or @option{--escape} option.
7424 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
7425 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
7428 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
7429 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
7430 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
7431 @t{'like this'} instead of @t{"like
7432 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
7435 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
7436 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. If that environment
7437 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{literal}, but this
7438 default may change to @samp{shell} in a future version of this package.
7440 @item --show-control-chars
7441 @opindex --show-control-chars
7442 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
7443 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
7449 @node dir invocation
7450 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
7453 @cindex directory listing, brief
7455 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
7456 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
7457 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
7459 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
7462 @node vdir invocation
7463 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
7466 @cindex directory listing, verbose
7468 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
7469 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
7470 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
7472 @node dircolors invocation
7473 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
7477 @cindex setup for color
7479 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
7480 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
7484 eval "$(dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}])"
7487 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
7488 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
7489 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
7490 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
7492 To make @command{dircolors} read a @file{~/.dircolors} file if it
7493 exists, you can put the following lines in your @file{~/.bashrc} (or
7494 adapt them to your favorite shell):
7498 test -r $d && eval "$(dircolors $d)"
7502 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
7503 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
7504 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
7505 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
7506 environment variable.
7508 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7513 @itemx --bourne-shell
7516 @opindex --bourne-shell
7517 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
7518 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
7519 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
7520 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
7529 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
7530 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
7531 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
7532 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
7535 @itemx --print-database
7537 @opindex --print-database
7538 @cindex color database, printing
7539 @cindex database for color setup, printing
7540 @cindex printing color database
7541 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
7542 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
7543 of the possibilities.
7550 @node Basic operations
7551 @chapter Basic operations
7553 @cindex manipulating files
7555 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
7556 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
7559 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
7560 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
7561 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
7562 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
7563 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
7564 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
7569 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
7572 @cindex copying files and directories
7573 @cindex files, copying
7574 @cindex directories, copying
7576 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
7577 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
7578 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
7582 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7583 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7584 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7589 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
7593 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7594 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7595 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7596 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
7597 using the @var{source}s' names.
7600 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
7601 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
7603 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
7604 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
7605 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
7606 to corresponding destination directories.
7608 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
7609 link only when not copying
7610 recursively. This default can be overridden with the
7611 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
7612 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
7613 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
7614 the last one silently overrides the others.
7616 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} follows the
7617 link only when it refers to an existing regular file.
7618 However, when copying to a dangling symbolic link, @command{cp}
7619 refuses by default, and fails with a diagnostic, since the operation
7620 is inherently dangerous. This behavior is contrary to historical
7621 practice and to @acronym{POSIX}.
7622 Set @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} to make @command{cp} attempt to create
7623 the target of a dangling destination symlink, in spite of the possible risk.
7624 Also, when an option like
7625 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
7626 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
7627 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
7629 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
7630 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
7631 @option{--copy-contents} option.
7633 @cindex self-backups
7634 @cindex backups, making only
7635 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
7636 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
7637 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
7638 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
7639 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
7640 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
7642 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7649 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
7650 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
7651 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
7652 directory in a different order).
7653 Try to preserve SELinux security context and extended attributes (xattr),
7654 but ignore any failure to do that and print no corresponding diagnostic.
7655 Equivalent to @option{-dR --preserve=all} with the reduced diagnostics.
7657 @itemx --attributes-only
7658 @opindex --attributes-only
7659 Copy only the specified attributes of the source file to the destination.
7660 If the destination already exists, do not alter its contents.
7661 See the @option{--preserve} option for controlling which attributes to copy.
7664 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
7667 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
7668 @cindex backups, making
7669 @xref{Backup options}.
7670 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
7671 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
7672 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
7673 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
7674 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
7678 # Usage: backup FILE...
7679 # Create a @sc{gnu}-style backup of each listed FILE.
7681 cp --backup --force -- "$i" "$i"
7685 @item --copy-contents
7686 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7687 @cindex copying directories recursively
7688 @cindex recursively copying directories
7689 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7690 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
7691 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
7692 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
7693 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
7694 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
7695 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
7696 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
7697 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
7698 fill up your destination disk if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
7699 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
7700 affect the copying of symbolic links.
7704 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7705 @cindex hard links, preserving
7706 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7707 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
7708 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
7714 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
7715 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force}),
7716 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then removes it and
7717 tries to open it again. Contrast this behavior with that enabled by
7718 @option{--link} and @option{--symbolic-link}, whereby the destination file
7719 is never opened but rather is removed unconditionally. Also see the
7720 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
7722 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
7723 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
7725 This option is redundant if the @option{--no-clobber} or @option{-n} option is
7730 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
7731 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
7732 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
7733 via recursive traversal.
7736 @itemx --interactive
7738 @opindex --interactive
7739 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
7740 overwrite an existing destination file. The @option{-i} option overrides
7741 a previous @option{-n} option.
7747 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
7750 @itemx --dereference
7752 @opindex --dereference
7753 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
7754 With this option, @command{cp} cannot create a symbolic link.
7755 For example, a symlink (to regular file) in the source tree will be copied to
7756 a regular file in the destination tree.
7761 @opindex --no-clobber
7762 Do not overwrite an existing file. The @option{-n} option overrides a previous
7763 @option{-i} option. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or
7764 @option{--backup} option.
7767 @itemx --no-dereference
7769 @opindex --no-dereference
7770 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7771 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7772 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
7773 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
7776 @itemx @w{@kbd{--preserve}[=@var{attribute_list}]}
7779 @cindex file information, preserving, extended attributes, xattr
7780 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
7781 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
7782 of one or more of the following strings:
7786 Preserve the file mode bits and access control lists.
7788 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
7789 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
7791 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
7792 a member of the desired group.
7794 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
7795 On older systems, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
7796 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
7797 However, many systems now provide the @code{utimensat} function,
7798 which makes it possible even for symbolic links.
7800 Preserve in the destination files
7801 any links between corresponding source files.
7802 Note that with @option{-L} or @option{-H}, this option can convert
7803 symbolic links to hard links. For example,
7805 $ mkdir c; : > a; ln -s a b; cp -aH a b c; ls -i1 c
7810 Note the inputs: @file{b} is a symlink to regular file @file{a},
7811 yet the files in destination directory, @file{c/}, are hard-linked.
7812 Since @option{-a} implies @option{--preserve=links}, and since @option{-H}
7813 tells @command{cp} to dereference command line arguments, it sees two files
7814 with the same inode number, and preserves the perceived hard link.
7816 Here is a similar example that exercises @command{cp}'s @option{-L} option:
7818 $ mkdir b c; (cd b; : > a; ln -s a b); cp -aL b c; ls -i1 c/b
7824 Preserve SELinux security context of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
7826 Preserve extended attributes of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
7827 If @command{cp} is built without xattr support, ignore this option.
7828 If SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities are implemented using xattrs,
7829 they are preserved by this option as well.
7831 Preserve all file attributes.
7832 Equivalent to specifying all of the above, but with the difference
7833 that failure to preserve SELinux security context or extended attributes
7834 does not change @command{cp}'s exit status. In contrast to @option{-a},
7835 all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
7838 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
7839 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
7841 In the absence of this option, each destination file is created with the
7842 mode bits of the corresponding source file, minus the bits set in the
7843 umask and minus the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits.
7844 @xref{File permissions}.
7846 @itemx @w{@kbd{--no-preserve}=@var{attribute_list}}
7847 @cindex file information, preserving
7848 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
7849 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
7853 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
7854 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
7855 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
7856 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
7857 For example, the command:
7860 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
7864 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
7865 any missing intermediate directories.
7872 @opindex --recursive
7873 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7874 @cindex copying directories recursively
7875 @cindex recursively copying directories
7876 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7877 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
7878 links in the source; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
7879 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
7880 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
7881 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
7882 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
7883 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
7884 non-@sc{gnu} systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
7885 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
7886 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
7887 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as @acronym{POSIX} allows
7888 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
7890 @item --reflink[=@var{when}]
7891 @opindex --reflink[=@var{when}]
7894 @cindex copy on write
7895 Perform a lightweight, copy-on-write (COW) copy, if supported by the
7896 file system. Once it has succeeded, beware that the source and destination
7897 files share the same disk data blocks as long as they remain unmodified.
7898 Thus, if a disk I/O error affects data blocks of one of the files,
7899 the other suffers the same fate.
7901 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
7905 The default behavior: if the copy-on-write operation is not supported
7906 then report the failure for each file and exit with a failure status.
7909 If the copy-on-write operation is not supported then fall back
7910 to the standard copy behaviour.
7913 This option is overridden by the @option{--link}, @option{--symbolic-link}
7914 and @option{--attributes-only} options, thus allowing it to be used
7915 to configure the default data copying behavior for @command{cp}.
7916 For example, with the following alias, @command{cp} will use the
7917 minimum amount of space supported by the file system.
7920 alias cp='cp --reflink=auto --sparse=always'
7923 @item --remove-destination
7924 @opindex --remove-destination
7925 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
7926 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
7928 @item --sparse=@var{when}
7929 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
7930 @cindex sparse files, copying
7931 @cindex holes, copying files with
7932 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
7933 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes}---a sequence of zero bytes that
7934 does not occupy any physical disk blocks; the @samp{read} system call
7935 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable disk space and
7936 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
7937 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
7938 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
7939 Only regular files may be sparse.
7941 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
7945 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
7946 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
7947 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
7950 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
7951 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
7952 input file does not appear to be sparse.
7953 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
7954 that does not support sparse files
7955 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
7956 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
7957 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
7958 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
7961 Never make the output file sparse.
7962 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
7963 since such a file must not have any holes.
7966 @optStripTrailingSlashes
7969 @itemx --symbolic-link
7971 @opindex --symbolic-link
7972 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
7973 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
7974 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
7975 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
7976 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
7982 @optNoTargetDirectory
7988 @cindex newer files, copying only
7989 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
7990 same or newer modification time. If time stamps are being preserved,
7991 the comparison is to the source time stamp truncated to the
7992 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
7993 used to update time stamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
7994 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and destination.
7995 If @option{--preserve=links} is also specified (like with @samp{cp -au}
7996 for example), that will take precedence. Consequently, depending on the
7997 order that files are processed from the source, newer files in the destination
7998 may be replaced, to mirror hard links in the source.
8004 Print the name of each file before copying it.
8007 @itemx --one-file-system
8009 @opindex --one-file-system
8010 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
8011 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
8012 the copy started on.
8013 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
8021 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
8024 @cindex converting while copying a file
8026 @command{dd} copies a file (from standard input to standard output, by
8027 default) with a changeable I/O block size, while optionally performing
8028 conversions on it. Synopses:
8031 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
8035 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
8036 @xref{Common options}. @command{dd} accepts the following operands.
8042 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
8046 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
8047 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, @command{dd} truncates @var{file} to zero
8048 bytes (or the size specified with @samp{seek=}).
8050 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
8052 @cindex block size of input
8053 @cindex input block size
8054 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
8055 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
8056 The default is 512 bytes.
8058 @item obs=@var{bytes}
8060 @cindex block size of output
8061 @cindex output block size
8062 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
8063 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
8064 The default is 512 bytes.
8066 @item bs=@var{bytes}
8069 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
8070 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
8071 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
8072 In addition, if no data-transforming @option{conv} option is specified,
8073 input is copied to the output as soon as it's read,
8074 even if it is smaller than the block size.
8076 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
8078 @cindex block size of conversion
8079 @cindex conversion block size
8080 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
8081 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
8082 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
8083 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
8084 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
8085 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
8089 Skip @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
8090 If @samp{iflag=skip_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8091 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8095 Skip @var{n} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before copying.
8096 if @samp{oflag=seek_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8097 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8101 Copy @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
8102 of everything until the end of the file.
8103 if @samp{iflag=count_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8104 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8108 Do not print the overall transfer rate and volume statistics
8109 that normally make up the third status line when @command{dd} exits.
8111 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
8113 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
8114 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8121 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
8122 Convert @acronym{EBCDIC} to @acronym{ASCII},
8123 using the conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
8124 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
8127 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
8128 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to @acronym{EBCDIC}.
8129 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
8132 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
8133 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to alternate @acronym{EBCDIC},
8134 using the alternate conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
8135 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
8136 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
8138 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
8142 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
8143 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
8144 input newline with a space and padding with spaces as necessary.
8148 Remove any trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block,
8149 and append a newline.
8151 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8154 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
8155 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
8158 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
8159 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
8161 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8165 Try to seek rather than write @sc{nul} output blocks.
8166 On a file system that supports sparse files, this will create
8167 sparse output when extending the output file.
8168 Be careful when using this option in conjunction with
8169 @samp{conv=notrunc} or @samp{oflag=append}.
8170 With @samp{conv=notrunc}, existing data in the output
8171 corresponding to @sc{nul} blocks from the input, will be untouched.
8172 With @samp{oflag=append} the seeks performed will be ineffective.
8175 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
8176 @cindex byte-swapping
8177 Swap every pair of input bytes. @sc{gnu} @command{dd}, unlike others, works
8178 when an odd number of bytes are read---the last byte is simply copied
8179 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
8182 @opindex sync @r{(padding with @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}s)}
8183 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
8184 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
8189 The following ``conversions'' are really file flags
8190 and don't affect internal processing:
8195 @cindex creating output file, requiring
8196 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
8201 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
8202 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
8204 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8208 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
8209 Do not truncate the output file.
8213 @cindex read errors, ignoring
8214 Continue after read errors.
8218 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
8219 Synchronize output data just before finishing. This forces a physical
8220 write of output data.
8224 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
8225 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing. This
8226 forces a physical write of output data and metadata.
8230 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
8232 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
8233 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8235 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
8237 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
8238 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8240 Here are the flags. Not every flag is supported on every operating
8247 @cindex appending to the output file
8248 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
8249 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
8250 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
8251 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
8252 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
8253 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
8257 @cindex concurrent I/O
8258 Use concurrent I/O mode for data. This mode performs direct I/O
8259 and drops the @acronym{POSIX} requirement to serialize all I/O to the same file.
8260 A file cannot be opened in CIO mode and with a standard open at the
8266 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
8267 Note that the kernel may impose restrictions on read or write buffer sizes.
8268 For example, with an ext4 destination file system and a linux-based kernel,
8269 using @samp{oflag=direct} will cause writes to fail with @code{EINVAL} if the
8270 output buffer size is not a multiple of 512.
8274 @cindex directory I/O
8276 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
8277 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
8281 @cindex synchronized data reads
8282 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
8283 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
8284 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
8285 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
8286 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
8290 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
8291 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
8295 @cindex discarding file cache
8296 Discard the data cache for a file.
8297 When count=0 all cache is discarded,
8298 otherwise the cache is dropped for the processed
8299 portion of the file. Also when count=0
8300 failure to discard the cache is diagnosed
8301 and reflected in the exit status.
8302 Here as some usage examples:
8305 # Advise to drop cache for whole file
8306 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache count=0
8308 # Ensure drop cache for the whole file
8309 dd of=ofile oflag=nocache conv=notrunc,fdatasync count=0
8311 # Drop cache for part of file
8312 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache skip=10 count=10 of=/dev/null
8314 # Stream data using just the read-ahead cache
8315 dd if=ifile of=ofile iflag=nocache oflag=nocache
8320 @cindex nonblocking I/O
8321 Use non-blocking I/O.
8326 Do not update the file's access time.
8327 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
8328 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
8332 @cindex controlling terminal
8333 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
8334 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
8335 On many hosts (e.g., @acronym{GNU}/Linux hosts), this option has no effect
8340 @cindex symbolic links, following
8341 Do not follow symbolic links.
8346 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
8351 Use binary I/O. This option has an effect only on nonstandard
8352 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
8357 Use text I/O. Like @samp{binary}, this option has no effect on
8362 Accumulate full blocks from input. The @code{read} system call
8363 may return early if a full block is not available.
8364 When that happens, continue calling @code{read} to fill the remainder
8366 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8369 @opindex count_bytes
8370 Interpret the @samp{count=} operand as a byte count,
8371 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8372 a length that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8373 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8377 Interpret the @samp{skip=} operand as a byte count,
8378 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8379 an offset that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8380 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8384 Interpret the @samp{seek=} operand as a byte count,
8385 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8386 an offset that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8387 This flag can be used only with @code{oflag}.
8391 These flags are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
8392 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
8393 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
8394 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
8395 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
8396 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
8400 @cindex multipliers after numbers
8401 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{bytes} and @var{blocks}) can be
8402 followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
8403 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
8404 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
8406 Any block size you specify via @samp{bs=}, @samp{ibs=}, @samp{obs=}, @samp{cbs=}
8407 should not be too large---values larger than a few megabytes
8408 are generally wasteful or (as in the gigabyte..exabyte case) downright
8409 counterproductive or error-inducing.
8411 To process data that is at an offset or size that is not a
8412 multiple of the I/O@ block size, you can use the @samp{skip_bytes},
8413 @samp{seek_bytes} and @samp{count_bytes} flags. Alternatively
8414 the traditional method of separate @command{dd} invocations can be used.
8415 For example, the following shell commands copy data
8416 in 512 KiB blocks between a disk and a tape, but do not save
8417 or restore a 4 KiB label at the start of the disk:
8420 disk=/dev/rdsk/c0t1d0s2
8423 # Copy all but the label from disk to tape.
8424 (dd bs=4k skip=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$disk >$tape
8426 # Copy from tape back to disk, but leave the disk label alone.
8427 (dd bs=4k seek=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$tape >$disk
8430 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal to a running @command{dd}
8431 process makes it print I/O statistics to standard error
8432 and then resume copying. In the example below,
8433 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 10 million blocks.
8434 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
8435 and when @command{dd} completes normally or is killed by the
8436 @code{SIGINT} signal, it outputs the final statistics.
8439 $ dd if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=10MB & pid=$!
8440 $ kill -s INFO $pid; wait $pid
8441 3385223+0 records in
8442 3385223+0 records out
8443 1733234176 bytes (1.7 GB) copied, 6.42173 seconds, 270 MB/s
8444 10000000+0 records in
8445 10000000+0 records out
8446 5120000000 bytes (5.1 GB) copied, 18.913 seconds, 271 MB/s
8449 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
8450 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
8451 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
8452 environment variable is set.
8457 @node install invocation
8458 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
8461 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
8463 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
8464 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
8467 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
8468 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
8469 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
8470 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
8475 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
8479 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8480 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8481 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8482 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
8483 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
8486 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
8487 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
8488 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
8489 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
8490 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
8491 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
8494 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
8495 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
8496 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
8497 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
8498 files onto themselves.
8500 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
8501 @command{install} never preserves extended attributes (xattr).
8503 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8513 Compare each pair of source and destination files, and if the destination has
8514 identical content and any specified owner, group, permissions, and possibly
8515 SELinux context, then do not modify the destination at all.
8519 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
8523 Create any missing parent directories of @var{dest},
8524 then copy @var{source} to @var{dest}.
8525 This option is ignored if a destination directory is specified
8526 via @option{--target-directory=DIR}.
8531 @opindex --directory
8532 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
8533 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
8534 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
8535 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
8536 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
8537 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
8539 @item -g @var{group}
8540 @itemx --group=@var{group}
8543 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
8544 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
8545 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
8546 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
8549 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8552 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
8553 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
8554 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
8555 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
8556 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
8557 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s}---read, write, and
8558 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
8559 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
8560 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
8561 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
8562 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
8564 @item -o @var{owner}
8565 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
8568 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
8569 @cindex appropriate privileges
8570 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
8571 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
8572 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
8573 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
8576 @item --preserve-context
8577 @opindex --preserve-context
8579 @cindex security context
8580 Preserve the SELinux security context of files and directories.
8581 Failure to preserve the context in all of the files or directories
8582 will result in an exit status of 1. If SELinux is disabled then
8583 print a warning and ignore the option.
8586 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
8588 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
8589 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
8590 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
8591 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
8592 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
8593 last modification times are both set to the time of installation.
8594 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification times
8595 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
8596 to when they were last installed.
8602 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
8603 @cindex stripping symbol table information
8604 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
8606 @itemx --strip-program=@var{program}
8607 @opindex --strip-program
8608 @cindex symbol table information, stripping, program
8609 Program used to strip binaries.
8615 @optNoTargetDirectory
8621 Print the name of each file before copying it.
8623 @item -Z @var{context}
8624 @itemx --context=@var{context}
8628 @cindex security context
8629 Set the default SELinux security context to be used for any
8630 created files and directories. If SELinux is disabled then
8631 print a warning and ignore the option.
8639 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
8643 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
8646 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
8647 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
8648 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
8653 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
8657 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8658 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8659 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8660 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
8661 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
8664 @command{mv} can move any type of file from one file system to another.
8665 Prior to version @code{4.0} of the fileutils,
8666 @command{mv} could move only regular files between file systems.
8667 For example, now @command{mv} can move an entire directory hierarchy
8668 including special device files from one partition to another. It first
8669 uses some of the same code that's used by @code{cp -a} to copy the
8670 requested directories and files, then (assuming the copy succeeded)
8671 it removes the originals. If the copy fails, then the part that was
8672 copied to the destination partition is removed. If you were to copy
8673 three directories from one partition to another and the copy of the first
8674 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
8675 the destination partition and the second and third would be left on the
8678 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
8679 @command{mv} always tries to copy extended attributes (xattr), which may
8680 include SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities.
8681 Upon failure all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
8683 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
8684 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
8685 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
8686 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
8687 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
8688 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
8690 @emph{Warning}: Avoid specifying a source name with a trailing slash,
8691 when it might be a symlink to a directory.
8692 Otherwise, @command{mv} may do something very surprising, since
8693 its behavior depends on the underlying rename system call.
8694 On a system with a modern Linux-based kernel, it fails with
8695 @code{errno=ENOTDIR}.
8696 However, on other systems (at least FreeBSD 6.1 and Solaris 10) it silently
8697 renames not the symlink but rather the directory referenced by the symlink.
8698 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
8700 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8710 @cindex prompts, omitting
8711 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
8713 If you specify more than one of the @option{-i}, @option{-f}, @option{-n}
8714 options, only the final one takes effect.
8719 @itemx --interactive
8721 @opindex --interactive
8722 @cindex prompts, forcing
8723 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
8725 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
8731 @opindex --no-clobber
8732 @cindex prompts, omitting
8733 Do not overwrite an existing file.
8735 This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or @option{--backup} option.
8741 @cindex newer files, moving only
8742 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
8743 same or newer modification time.
8744 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
8745 source time stamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
8746 system and of the system calls used to update time stamps; this avoids
8747 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
8748 same source and destination.
8754 Print the name of each file before moving it.
8756 @optStripTrailingSlashes
8762 @optNoTargetDirectory
8770 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
8773 @cindex removing files or directories
8775 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
8776 directories. Synopsis:
8779 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
8782 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
8783 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
8784 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
8785 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
8786 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
8787 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
8789 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
8790 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
8791 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
8792 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
8793 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
8795 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
8796 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting.
8798 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
8799 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
8800 that the contents are truly unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
8802 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8810 Ignore nonexistent files and missing operands, and never prompt the user.
8811 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
8815 Prompt whether to remove each file.
8816 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
8817 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
8818 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
8822 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
8823 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
8824 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
8825 @option{--interactive=once}.
8827 @itemx --interactive [=@var{when}]
8828 @opindex --interactive
8829 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
8833 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
8834 - Do not prompt at all.
8836 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
8837 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
8838 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
8840 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
8841 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
8843 @option{--interactive} with no @var{when} is equivalent to
8844 @option{--interactive=always}.
8846 @itemx --one-file-system
8847 @opindex --one-file-system
8848 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
8849 When removing a hierarchy recursively, skip any directory that is on a
8850 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
8853 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
8854 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
8855 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
8856 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
8857 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
8858 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
8859 under @file{/home}, too.
8860 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
8861 warn about and skip directories on other file systems.
8862 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
8863 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
8865 @itemx --preserve-root
8866 @opindex --preserve-root
8867 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
8868 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
8869 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
8870 This is the default behavior.
8871 @xref{Treating / specially}.
8873 @itemx --no-preserve-root
8874 @opindex --no-preserve-root
8875 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
8876 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
8877 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
8878 remove all the files on your computer.
8879 @xref{Treating / specially}.
8886 @opindex --recursive
8887 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
8888 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
8894 Print the name of each file before removing it.
8898 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
8899 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
8900 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
8901 @samp{-}. @sc{gnu} @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
8902 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
8903 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
8904 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
8917 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
8918 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
8919 predates the development of the getopt standard syntax.
8924 @node shred invocation
8925 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
8928 @cindex data, erasing
8929 @cindex erasing data
8931 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
8932 very expensive hardware from recovering the data.
8934 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), the data is
8935 not actually destroyed. Only the index listing where the file is
8936 stored is destroyed, and the storage is made available for reuse.
8937 There are undelete utilities that will attempt to reconstruct the index
8938 and can bring the file back if the parts were not reused.
8940 On a busy system with a nearly-full drive, space can get reused in a few
8941 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. If you have sensitive
8942 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible by actually
8943 overwriting the file with non-sensitive data.
8945 However, even after doing that, it is possible to take the disk back
8946 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
8947 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
8948 overwritten data. If the data has only been overwritten once, it's not
8951 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
8952 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
8953 like floppy disks, this is the preferred method. However, hard drives
8954 are expensive and hard to melt, so the @command{shred} utility tries
8955 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively.
8957 This uses many overwrite passes, with the data patterns chosen to
8958 maximize the damage they do to the old data. While this will work on
8959 floppies, the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives.
8960 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
8961 @uref{http://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
8962 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
8963 from the proceedings of the Sixth @acronym{USENIX} Security Symposium (San Jose,
8964 California, July 22--25, 1996).
8966 @strong{Please note} that @command{shred} relies on a very important assumption:
8967 that the file system overwrites data in place. This is the traditional
8968 way to do things, but many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
8969 assumption. Exceptions include:
8974 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as those supplied with
8975 AIX and Solaris, and JFS, ReiserFS, XFS, Ext3 (in @code{data=journal} mode),
8976 BFS, NTFS, etc.@: when they are configured to journal @emph{data}.
8979 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
8980 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
8983 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
8986 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
8990 Compressed file systems.
8993 In the particular case of ext3 file systems, the above disclaimer applies (and
8994 @command{shred} is thus of limited effectiveness) only in @code{data=journal}
8995 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
8996 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
8997 @command{shred} works as usual. Ext3 journaling modes can be changed
8998 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
8999 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
9000 the mount man page (man mount).
9002 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
9003 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means that shred cannot
9004 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
9006 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
9007 since this bypasses the problem of file system design mentioned above.
9008 However, even shredding devices is not always completely reliable. For
9009 example, most disks map out bad sectors invisibly to the application; if
9010 the bad sectors contain sensitive data, @command{shred} won't be able to
9013 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report this problem, just as
9014 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
9015 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
9016 not truncate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
9017 for devices, which typically cannot be truncated and should not be
9020 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
9021 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
9022 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
9023 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
9024 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
9027 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
9030 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9038 @cindex force deletion
9039 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
9042 @itemx -n @var{number}
9043 @itemx --iterations=@var{number}
9044 @opindex -n @var{number}
9045 @opindex --iterations=@var{number}
9046 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
9047 By default, @command{shred} uses @value{SHRED_DEFAULT_PASSES} passes of
9048 overwrite. You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you think it's
9049 appropriate. After 25 passes all of the internal overwrite patterns will have
9050 been used at least once.
9052 @item --random-source=@var{file}
9053 @opindex --random-source
9054 @cindex random source for shredding
9055 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
9056 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
9058 @item -s @var{bytes}
9059 @itemx --size=@var{bytes}
9060 @opindex -s @var{bytes}
9061 @opindex --size=@var{bytes}
9062 @cindex size of file to shred
9063 Shred the first @var{bytes} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
9064 the whole file. @var{bytes} can be followed by a size specification like
9065 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
9071 @cindex removing files after shredding
9072 After shredding a file, truncate it (if possible) and then remove it.
9073 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
9079 Display to standard error all status updates as sterilization proceeds.
9085 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
9086 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the last block
9088 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
9089 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
9090 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
9091 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
9097 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
9098 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your hard drive (for
9099 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
9100 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
9101 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
9102 by the @option{--iterations} option.
9106 You might use the following command to erase all trace of the
9107 file system you'd created on the floppy disk in your first drive.
9108 That command takes about 20 minutes to erase a ``1.44MB'' (actually
9112 shred --verbose /dev/fd0
9115 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
9116 your hard disk, you could give a command like this:
9119 shred --verbose /dev/sda5
9122 On modern disks, a single pass should be adequate,
9123 and it will take one third the time of the default three-pass approach.
9126 # 1 pass, write pseudo-random data; 3x faster than the default
9127 shred --verbose -n1 /dev/sda5
9130 To be on the safe side, use at least one pass that overwrites using
9131 pseudo-random data. I.e., don't be tempted to use @samp{-n0 --zero},
9132 in case some disk controller optimizes the process of writing blocks
9133 of all zeros, and thereby does not clear all bytes in a block.
9134 Some SSDs may do just that.
9136 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
9137 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
9144 echo "Hello, world" >&3
9149 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
9150 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
9151 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
9152 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
9157 @node Special file types
9158 @chapter Special file types
9160 @cindex special file types
9161 @cindex file types, special
9163 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
9164 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
9166 @cindex special file types
9168 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
9169 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
9170 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
9171 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
9172 which it does in a @dfn{directory}---a special type of file. Although
9173 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
9174 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
9175 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
9177 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
9178 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
9181 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
9182 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
9183 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
9184 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
9185 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
9186 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name.
9187 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
9188 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
9192 @node link invocation
9193 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
9196 @cindex links, creating
9197 @cindex hard links, creating
9198 @cindex creating links (hard only)
9200 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
9201 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
9202 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
9203 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
9204 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
9205 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
9209 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
9212 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
9213 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
9214 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
9217 On a @acronym{GNU} system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
9218 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
9219 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
9220 not specified by @acronym{POSIX}, and the @command{link} command is
9221 more portable in practice.
9223 If @var{filename} is a symbolic link, it is unspecified whether
9224 @var{linkname} will be a hard link to the symbolic link or to the
9225 target of the symbolic link. Use @command{ln -P} or @command{ln -L}
9226 to specify which behavior is desired.
9232 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
9235 @cindex links, creating
9236 @cindex hard links, creating
9237 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
9238 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
9240 @cindex file systems and hard links
9241 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
9242 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
9246 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
9247 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
9248 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
9249 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
9255 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
9256 file from the second.
9259 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
9260 in the current directory.
9263 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
9264 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
9265 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
9266 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
9267 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
9271 Normally @command{ln} does not remove existing files. Use the
9272 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to remove them unconditionally,
9273 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to remove them
9274 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
9277 @cindex hard link, defined
9278 @cindex inode, and hard links
9279 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
9280 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
9281 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
9282 file---indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
9283 file. Most systems prohibit making a hard link to
9284 a directory; on those where it is allowed, only the super-user can do
9285 so (and with caution, since creating a cycle will cause problems to many
9286 other utilities). Hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
9287 restrictions are not mandated by @acronym{POSIX}, however.)
9289 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
9290 @cindex symbolic link, defined
9291 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
9292 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
9293 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
9294 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
9295 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
9296 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
9297 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
9298 link file itself, rather than on its target. The owner and group of a
9299 symlink are not significant to file access performed through
9300 the link, but do have implications on deleting a symbolic link from a
9301 directory with the restricted deletion bit set. On the GNU system,
9302 the mode of a symlink has no significance and cannot be changed, but
9303 on some BSD systems, the mode can be changed and will affect whether
9304 the symlink will be traversed in file name resolution. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
9305 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
9307 Symbolic links can contain arbitrary strings; a @dfn{dangling symlink}
9308 occurs when the string in the symlink does not resolve to a file.
9309 There are no restrictions against creating dangling symbolic links.
9310 There are trade-offs to using absolute or relative symlinks. An
9311 absolute symlink always points to the same file, even if the directory
9312 containing the link is moved. However, if the symlink is visible from
9313 more than one machine (such as on a networked file system), the file
9314 pointed to might not always be the same. A relative symbolic link is
9315 resolved in relation to the directory that contains the link, and is
9316 often useful in referring to files on the same device without regards
9317 to what name that device is mounted on when accessed via networked
9320 When creating a relative symlink in a different location than the
9321 current directory, the resolution of the symlink will be different
9322 than the resolution of the same string from the current directory.
9323 Therefore, many users prefer to first change directories to the
9324 location where the relative symlink will be created, so that
9325 tab-completion or other file resolution will find the same target as
9326 what will be placed in the symlink.
9328 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9339 @opindex --directory
9340 @cindex hard links to directories
9341 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
9343 However, note that this will probably fail due to
9344 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
9350 Remove existing destination files.
9353 @itemx --interactive
9355 @opindex --interactive
9356 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
9357 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files.
9363 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
9364 link, create the hard link to the file referred to by the symbolic
9365 link, rather than the symbolic link itself.
9368 @itemx --no-dereference
9370 @opindex --no-dereference
9371 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
9372 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
9374 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
9375 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
9376 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
9377 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
9378 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
9379 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
9380 non-directory---as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
9381 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
9382 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
9383 just like a directory.
9385 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
9386 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
9392 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
9393 link, create the hard link to the symbolic link itself. On platforms
9394 where this is not supported by the kernel, this option creates a
9395 symbolic link with identical contents; since symbolic link contents
9396 cannot be edited, any file name resolution performed through either
9397 link will be the same as if a hard link had been created.
9403 Make symbolic links relative to the link location.
9408 ln -srv /a/file /tmp
9409 '/tmp/file' -> '../a/file'
9412 @xref{realpath invocation}, which gives greater control
9413 over relative file name generation.
9419 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
9420 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
9426 @optNoTargetDirectory
9432 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
9436 @cindex hard links to symbolic links
9437 @cindex symbolic links and @command{ln}
9438 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
9439 precedence. If @option{-s} is also given, @option{-L} and @option{-P}
9440 are silently ignored. If neither option is given, then this
9441 implementation defaults to @option{-P} if the system @code{link} supports
9442 hard links to symbolic links (such as the GNU system), and @option{-L}
9443 if @code{link} follows symbolic links (such as on BSD).
9452 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
9453 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
9458 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
9464 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
9465 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
9469 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
9470 # work across networked file systems.
9471 ln -s afile anotherfile
9472 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
9476 @node mkdir invocation
9477 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
9480 @cindex directories, creating
9481 @cindex creating directories
9483 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
9486 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
9489 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
9490 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
9491 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
9493 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9498 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
9501 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
9502 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
9503 which uses the same syntax as
9504 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
9505 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
9507 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
9508 is created. As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @var{mode} may also mention
9509 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
9510 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
9511 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
9512 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
9513 overridden in this way.
9519 @cindex parent directories, creating
9520 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
9521 file permission bits to the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
9522 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
9525 To set the file permission bits of any newly-created parent
9526 directories to a value that includes @samp{u+wx}, you can set the
9527 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
9528 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
9529 @file{P} it sets the parent's permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
9530 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
9531 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
9532 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
9533 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
9539 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
9542 @item -Z @var{context}
9543 @itemx --context=@var{context}
9547 @cindex security context
9548 Set the default SELinux security context to be used for created directories.
9555 @node mkfifo invocation
9556 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
9559 @cindex FIFOs, creating
9560 @cindex named pipes, creating
9561 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
9563 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
9564 specified names. Synopsis:
9567 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
9570 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
9571 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
9572 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
9573 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
9575 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9580 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
9583 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
9584 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
9585 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
9586 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
9587 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
9589 @item -Z @var{context}
9590 @itemx --context=@var{context}
9594 @cindex security context
9595 Set the default SELinux security context to be used for created FIFOs.
9602 @node mknod invocation
9603 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
9606 @cindex block special files, creating
9607 @cindex character special files, creating
9609 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
9610 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
9613 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
9616 @cindex special files
9617 @cindex block special files
9618 @cindex character special files
9619 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
9620 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
9621 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
9622 e.g., a printer or a disk. (These files are typically created at
9623 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
9624 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
9625 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
9626 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
9628 @c mknod is a shell built-in at least with OpenBSD's /bin/sh
9629 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{mknod}
9631 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
9636 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
9640 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
9641 for a block special file
9644 @c Don't document the 'u' option -- it's just a synonym for 'c'.
9645 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
9647 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
9648 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
9649 for a character special file
9653 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
9654 device numbers must be given after the file type.
9655 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
9656 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
9657 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
9659 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9664 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
9667 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
9668 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
9669 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
9670 @xref{File permissions}.
9672 @item -Z @var{context}
9673 @itemx --context=@var{context}
9677 @cindex security context
9678 Set the default SELinux security context to be used for created files.
9685 @node readlink invocation
9686 @section @command{readlink}: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
9689 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
9690 @cindex canonical file name
9691 @cindex canonicalize a file name
9694 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
9700 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic link.
9701 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
9702 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
9704 @item Canonicalize mode
9706 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given file which contains
9707 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
9708 (@file{/}) or symbolic links.
9713 readlink [@var{option}] @var{file}
9716 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
9718 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9723 @itemx --canonicalize
9725 @opindex --canonicalize
9726 Activate canonicalize mode.
9727 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
9728 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit
9729 code. A trailing slash is ignored.
9732 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
9734 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
9735 Activate canonicalize mode.
9736 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
9737 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code. A trailing slash
9738 requires that the name resolve to a directory.
9741 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
9743 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
9744 Activate canonicalize mode.
9745 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
9751 @opindex --no-newline
9752 Do not output the trailing newline.
9762 Suppress most error messages.
9768 Report error messages.
9772 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
9774 The @command{realpath} command without options, operates like
9775 @command{readlink} in canonicalize mode.
9780 @node rmdir invocation
9781 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
9784 @cindex removing empty directories
9785 @cindex directories, removing empty
9787 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
9790 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
9793 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
9794 directory, it is an error.
9796 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9800 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
9801 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
9802 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
9803 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is solely because
9804 the directory is non-empty.
9810 @cindex parent directories, removing
9811 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
9812 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
9813 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
9814 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
9815 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
9816 exit unsuccessfully.
9822 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
9823 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
9824 @var{directory} is removed.
9828 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories (recursively).
9833 @node unlink invocation
9834 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
9837 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
9839 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
9840 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
9841 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
9842 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
9843 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
9844 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
9847 unlink @var{filename}
9850 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
9851 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
9852 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
9854 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
9855 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
9856 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
9861 @node Changing file attributes
9862 @chapter Changing file attributes
9864 @cindex changing file attributes
9865 @cindex file attributes, changing
9866 @cindex attributes, file
9868 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
9869 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
9870 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
9871 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
9872 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
9875 These commands change file attributes.
9878 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
9879 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
9880 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
9881 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
9885 @node chown invocation
9886 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
9889 @cindex file ownership, changing
9890 @cindex group ownership, changing
9891 @cindex changing file ownership
9892 @cindex changing group ownership
9894 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
9895 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
9899 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
9903 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
9904 (with no embedded white space):
9907 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
9914 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
9915 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
9918 @item owner@samp{:}group
9919 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
9920 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
9921 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
9924 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
9925 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
9926 @var{owner}'s login group.
9929 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
9930 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
9931 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
9934 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
9935 owner nor the group is changed.
9939 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
9940 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
9941 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
9943 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
9944 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
9945 require support for that, but for backward compatibility @acronym{GNU}
9946 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results.
9947 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
9948 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
9949 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
9952 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
9953 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
9954 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
9955 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
9956 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
9957 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
9958 privileges, or when the
9959 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
9961 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
9963 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9971 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
9972 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
9981 @cindex error messages, omitting
9982 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
9985 @itemx @w{@kbd{--from}=@var{old-owner}}
9987 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9988 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
9989 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
9991 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
9992 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
9993 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
9994 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
9997 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 chown -h NEWUSER
10000 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
10001 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{chown} is actually run
10002 may be quite large.
10003 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke chown for each file
10007 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec chown -h NEWUSER @{@} \;
10010 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
10011 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
10012 though still not perfect:
10015 chown -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
10018 @item --dereference
10019 @opindex --dereference
10020 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10022 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
10023 This is the default.
10026 @itemx --no-dereference
10028 @opindex --no-dereference
10029 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10031 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
10032 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
10033 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
10034 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
10035 is a symbolic link.
10036 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
10037 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
10039 @itemx --preserve-root
10040 @opindex --preserve-root
10041 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10042 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10043 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10044 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10046 @itemx --no-preserve-root
10047 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10048 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10049 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10050 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10052 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10053 @opindex --reference
10054 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
10055 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
10056 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
10063 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
10064 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
10065 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
10066 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
10067 its referent is being changed.
10072 @opindex --recursive
10073 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
10074 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
10077 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10080 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10083 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10092 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
10095 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
10096 chown root:staff /u
10098 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
10103 @node chgrp invocation
10104 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
10107 @cindex group ownership, changing
10108 @cindex changing group ownership
10110 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
10111 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
10112 or to the group of an existing reference file. Synopsis:
10115 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
10119 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
10120 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
10121 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
10123 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10131 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
10132 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
10141 @cindex error messages, omitting
10142 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
10145 @item --dereference
10146 @opindex --dereference
10147 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10149 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
10150 This is the default.
10153 @itemx --no-dereference
10155 @opindex --no-dereference
10156 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
10158 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
10159 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
10160 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
10161 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
10162 is a symbolic link.
10163 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
10164 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
10166 @itemx --preserve-root
10167 @opindex --preserve-root
10168 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10169 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10170 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10171 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10173 @itemx --no-preserve-root
10174 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10175 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10176 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10177 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10179 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10180 @opindex --reference
10181 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
10182 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
10183 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
10189 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
10190 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
10191 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
10192 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
10193 its referent is being changed.
10198 @opindex --recursive
10199 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
10200 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
10203 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10206 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10209 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10218 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
10221 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
10226 @node chmod invocation
10227 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
10230 @cindex changing access permissions
10231 @cindex access permissions, changing
10232 @cindex permissions, changing access
10234 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
10237 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
10241 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
10242 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
10243 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
10244 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
10245 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
10246 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
10247 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
10248 recursive directory traversals.
10250 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
10251 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
10252 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
10253 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
10254 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
10255 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
10256 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
10257 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
10259 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
10260 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
10261 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
10262 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
10263 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
10264 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
10265 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
10267 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10275 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
10284 @cindex error messages, omitting
10285 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
10288 @itemx --preserve-root
10289 @opindex --preserve-root
10290 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10291 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10292 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10293 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10295 @itemx --no-preserve-root
10296 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10297 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10298 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10299 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10305 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
10307 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10308 @opindex --reference
10309 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
10310 @xref{File permissions}.
10311 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
10312 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
10317 @opindex --recursive
10318 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
10319 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
10326 @node touch invocation
10327 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
10330 @cindex changing file timestamps
10331 @cindex file timestamps, changing
10332 @cindex timestamps, changing file
10334 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification times of the
10335 specified files. Synopsis:
10338 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
10341 @cindex empty files, creating
10342 Any @var{file} argument that does not exist is created empty, unless
10343 option @option{--no-create} (@option{-c}) or @option{--no-dereference}
10344 (@option{-h}) was in effect.
10346 A @var{file} argument string of @samp{-} is handled specially and
10347 causes @command{touch} to change the times of the file associated with
10351 By default, @command{touch} sets file timestamps to the current time.
10352 Because @command{touch} acts on its operands left to right, the
10353 resulting timestamps of earlier and later operands may disagree.
10354 Also, the determination of what time is ``current'' depends on the
10355 platform. Platforms with network file systems often use different
10356 clocks for the operating system and for file systems; because
10357 @command{touch} typically uses file systems' clocks by default, clock
10358 skew can cause the resulting file timestamps to appear to be in a
10359 program's ``future'' or ``past''.
10361 @cindex file timestamp resolution
10362 The @command{touch} command sets the file's timestamp to the greatest
10363 representable value that is not greater than the requested time. This
10364 can differ from the requested time for several reasons. First, the
10365 requested time may have a higher resolution than supported. Second, a
10366 file system may use different resolutions for different types of
10367 times. Third, file timestamps may use a different resolution than
10368 operating system timestamps. Fourth, the operating system primitives
10369 used to update timestamps may employ yet a different resolution. For
10370 example, in theory a file system might use 10-microsecond resolution
10371 for access time and 100-nanosecond resolution for modification time,
10372 and the operating system might use nanosecond resolution for the
10373 current time and microsecond resolution for the primitive that
10374 @command{touch} uses to set a file's timestamp to an arbitrary value.
10376 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
10377 When setting file timestamps to the current time, @command{touch} can
10378 change the timestamps for files that the user does not own but has
10379 write permission for. Otherwise, the user must own the files. Some
10380 older systems have a further restriction: the user must own the files
10381 unless both the access and modification times are being set to the
10384 Although @command{touch} provides options for changing two of the times---the
10385 times of last access and modification---of a file, there is actually
10386 a standard third one as well: the inode change time. This is often
10387 referred to as a file's @code{ctime}.
10388 The inode change time represents the time when the file's meta-information
10389 last changed. One common example of this is when the permissions of a
10390 file change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so
10391 the atime doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime
10392 doesn't change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed,
10393 and this must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field.
10394 This is necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a
10395 fresh copy of the file, including the new permissions value.
10396 Another operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting
10397 the others is renaming. In any case, it is not possible, in normal
10398 operations, for a user to change the ctime field to a user-specified value.
10399 Some operating systems and file systems support a fourth time: the
10400 birth time, when the file was first created; by definition, this
10401 timestamp never changes.
10404 Time stamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
10405 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
10406 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
10407 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10408 You can avoid ambiguities during
10409 daylight saving transitions by using @sc{utc} time stamps.
10411 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10416 @itemx --time=atime
10417 @itemx --time=access
10421 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
10422 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
10423 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
10424 Change the access time only.
10429 @opindex --no-create
10430 Do not warn about or create files that do not exist.
10433 @itemx --date=@var{time}
10437 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
10438 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
10439 example, @option{--date="2004-02-27 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
10440 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
10441 February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
10442 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. @xref{Date input formats}.
10443 File systems that do not support high-resolution time stamps
10444 silently ignore any excess precision here.
10448 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
10449 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
10452 @itemx --no-dereference
10454 @opindex --no-dereference
10455 @cindex symbolic links, changing time
10457 Attempt to change the timestamps of a symbolic link, rather than what
10458 the link refers to. When using this option, empty files are not
10459 created, but option @option{-c} must also be used to avoid warning
10460 about files that do not exist. Not all systems support changing the
10461 timestamps of symlinks, since underlying system support for this
10462 action was not required until @acronym{POSIX} 2008. Also, on some
10463 systems, the mere act of examining a symbolic link changes the access
10464 time, such that only changes to the modification time will persist
10465 long enough to be observable. When coupled with option @option{-r}, a
10466 reference timestamp is taken from a symbolic link rather than the file
10470 @itemx --time=mtime
10471 @itemx --time=modify
10474 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
10475 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
10476 Change the modification time only.
10478 @item -r @var{file}
10479 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
10481 @opindex --reference
10482 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
10483 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
10484 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
10485 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
10486 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a time stamp
10487 equal to five seconds before the corresponding time stamp for @file{foo}.
10488 If @var{file} is a symbolic link, the reference timestamp is taken
10489 from the target of the symlink, unless @option{-h} was also in effect.
10491 @item -t [[@var{cc}]@var{yy}]@var{mmddhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
10492 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
10493 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
10494 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{cc}
10495 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
10496 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
10497 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
10498 Note that @var{ss} may be @samp{60}, to accommodate leap seconds.
10502 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
10503 On older systems, @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
10504 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
10505 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
10506 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{mmddhhmm}[@var{yy}]} and this
10507 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{yy}, if
10508 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
10509 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
10510 for the other files instead of as a file name.
10511 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
10512 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
10513 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
10514 behavior depends on this variable.
10515 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
10516 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
10522 @chapter Disk usage
10526 No disk can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
10527 how much disk storage is in use or available, report other file and
10528 file status information, and write buffers to disk.
10531 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage.
10532 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
10533 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
10534 * sync invocation:: Synchronize memory and disk.
10535 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file.
10539 @node df invocation
10540 @section @command{df}: Report file system disk space usage
10543 @cindex file system disk usage
10544 @cindex disk usage by file system
10546 @command{df} reports the amount of disk space used and available on
10547 file systems. Synopsis:
10550 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
10553 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
10554 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
10555 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
10557 Normally the disk space is printed in units of
10558 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
10559 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
10561 @cindex disk device file
10562 @cindex device file, disk
10563 If an argument @var{file} is a disk device file containing a mounted
10564 file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that file system
10565 rather than on the file system containing the device node (i.e., the root
10566 file system). @sc{gnu} @command{df} does not attempt to determine the
10568 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
10569 requires extremely nonportable intimate knowledge of file system
10572 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10580 @cindex automounter file systems
10581 @cindex ignore file systems
10582 Include in the listing dummy file systems, which
10583 are omitted by default. Such file systems are typically special-purpose
10584 pseudo-file-systems, such as automounter entries.
10586 @item -B @var{size}
10587 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
10589 @opindex --block-size
10590 @cindex file system sizes
10591 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
10592 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
10596 @cindex grand total of disk size, usage and available space
10597 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
10598 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk size, usage
10599 and available space of all listed devices.
10605 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
10611 @cindex inode usage
10612 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
10613 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
10614 permissions, timestamps, and location on the disk.
10618 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
10619 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
10620 (@pxref{Block size}).
10621 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
10627 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
10628 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
10633 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
10634 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
10635 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
10636 disks, but on some systems (notably SunOS) the results may be slightly
10637 out of date. This is the default.
10640 @itemx --portability
10642 @opindex --portability
10643 @cindex one-line output format
10644 @cindex @acronym{POSIX} output format
10645 @cindex portable output format
10646 @cindex output format, portable
10647 Use the @acronym{POSIX} output format. This is like the default format except
10652 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
10653 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
10654 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
10655 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
10658 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to @acronym{POSIX}.
10661 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
10662 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
10663 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
10664 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
10665 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
10672 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
10673 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
10674 some systems (notably SunOS), doing this yields more up to date results,
10675 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
10676 there are many or very busy file systems.
10678 @item -t @var{fstype}
10679 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
10682 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
10683 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
10684 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
10685 By default, nothing is omitted.
10688 @itemx --print-type
10690 @opindex --print-type
10691 @cindex file system types, printing
10692 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
10693 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
10694 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
10695 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
10700 @cindex @acronym{NFS} file system type
10701 An @acronym{NFS} file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
10702 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
10705 @item 4.2@r{, }ufs@r{, }efs@dots{}
10706 @cindex Linux file system types
10707 @cindex local file system types
10708 @opindex 4.2 @r{file system type}
10709 @opindex ufs @r{file system type}
10710 @opindex efs @r{file system type}
10711 A file system on a locally-mounted hard disk. (The system might even
10712 support more than one type here; Linux does.)
10714 @item hsfs@r{, }cdfs
10715 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
10716 @cindex High Sierra file system
10717 @opindex hsfs @r{file system type}
10718 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
10719 A file system on a CD-ROM drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
10720 systems use @samp{hsfs} (@samp{hs} for ``High Sierra'').
10723 @cindex PC file system
10724 @cindex DOS file system
10725 @cindex MS-DOS file system
10726 @cindex diskette file system
10728 An MS-DOS file system, usually on a diskette.
10732 @item -x @var{fstype}
10733 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
10735 @opindex --exclude-type
10736 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
10737 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
10738 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
10741 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
10746 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
10747 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
10748 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
10749 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
10752 @node du invocation
10753 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
10756 @cindex file space usage
10757 @cindex disk usage for files
10759 @command{du} reports the amount of disk space used by the specified files
10760 and for each subdirectory (of directory arguments). Synopsis:
10763 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
10766 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the disk space for the current
10767 directory. Normally the disk space is printed in units of
10768 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
10769 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
10771 If two or more hard links point to the same file, only one of the hard
10772 links is counted. The @var{file} argument order affects which links
10773 are counted, and changing the argument order may change the numbers
10774 that @command{du} outputs.
10776 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10784 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
10786 @itemx --apparent-size
10787 @opindex --apparent-size
10788 Print apparent sizes, rather than disk usage. The apparent size of a
10789 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
10790 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
10791 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
10792 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
10793 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of disk space, depending on
10794 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
10795 However, a sparse file created with this command:
10798 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
10802 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
10803 systems, it actually uses almost no disk space.
10809 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
10811 @item -B @var{size}
10812 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
10814 @opindex --block-size
10816 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
10817 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
10823 @cindex grand total of disk space
10824 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
10825 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk usage of
10826 a given set of files or directories.
10829 @itemx --dereference-args
10831 @opindex --dereference-args
10832 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
10833 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
10834 out the disk usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
10835 are often symbolic links.
10837 @c --files0-from=FILE
10838 @filesZeroFromOption{du,, with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option}
10844 Equivalent to @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
10848 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
10849 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
10850 (@pxref{Block size}).
10851 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
10854 @itemx --count-links
10856 @opindex --count-links
10857 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
10858 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
10862 @itemx --dereference
10864 @opindex --dereference
10865 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
10866 Dereference symbolic links (show the disk space used by the file
10867 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
10872 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
10873 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
10874 (@pxref{Block size}).
10875 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
10878 @itemx --no-dereference
10880 @opindex --no-dereference
10881 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
10882 For each symbolic links encountered by @command{du},
10883 consider the disk space used by the symbolic link.
10885 @item -d @var{depth}
10886 @item --max-depth=@var{depth}
10887 @opindex -d @var{depth}
10888 @opindex --max-depth=@var{depth}
10889 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
10890 Show the total for each directory (and file if --all) that is at
10891 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
10892 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
10901 @opindex --summarize
10902 Display only a total for each argument.
10905 @itemx --separate-dirs
10907 @opindex --separate-dirs
10908 Normally, in the output of @command{du} (when not using @option{--summarize}),
10909 the size listed next to a directory name, @var{d}, represents the sum
10910 of sizes of all entries beneath @var{d} as well as the size of @var{d} itself.
10911 With @option{--separate-dirs}, the size reported for a directory name,
10912 @var{d}, is merely the @code{stat.st_size}-derived size of the directory
10917 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
10918 Show time of the most recent modification of any file in the directory,
10919 or any of its subdirectories.
10921 @itemx --time=ctime
10922 @itemx --time=status
10925 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
10926 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
10927 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
10928 Show the most recent status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) of
10929 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
10931 @itemx --time=atime
10932 @itemx --time=access
10934 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
10935 @opindex access time@r{, show the most recent}
10936 Show the most recent access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode) of
10937 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
10939 @item --time-style=@var{style}
10940 @opindex --time-style
10942 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
10943 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
10944 be one of the following:
10947 @item +@var{format}
10949 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
10950 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
10951 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
10952 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
10953 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
10954 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
10957 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
10958 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
10959 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
10960 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
10963 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
10964 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
10965 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
10966 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
10969 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30}.
10970 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
10974 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
10975 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
10976 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
10977 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
10978 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
10979 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
10980 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
10983 @itemx --one-file-system
10985 @opindex --one-file-system
10986 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
10987 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
10988 the argument being processed is on.
10990 @item --exclude=@var{pattern}
10991 @opindex --exclude=@var{pattern}
10992 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
10993 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{pattern}.
10994 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
10997 @item -X @var{file}
10998 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{file}
10999 @opindex -X @var{file}
11000 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{file}
11001 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
11002 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{file},
11003 one per line. If @var{file} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
11008 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
11009 On BSD systems, @command{du} reports sizes that are half the correct
11010 values for files that are NFS-mounted from HP-UX systems. On HP-UX
11011 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for
11012 files that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw
11013 in HP-UX; it also affects the HP-UX @command{du} program.
11018 @node stat invocation
11019 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
11022 @cindex file status
11023 @cindex file system status
11025 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
11028 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11031 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
11032 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
11033 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
11034 also give information about the files the links point to.
11036 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{stat}
11041 @itemx --dereference
11043 @opindex --dereference
11044 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
11045 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
11046 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
11047 by each symbolic link argument.
11048 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
11051 @itemx --file-system
11053 @opindex --file-system
11054 @cindex file systems
11055 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
11056 instead of information about the files themselves.
11057 This option implies the @option{-L} option.
11060 @itemx --format=@var{format}
11062 @opindex --format=@var{format}
11063 @cindex output format
11064 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
11065 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
11066 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
11067 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
11069 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
11074 @itemx --printf=@var{format}
11075 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
11076 @cindex output format
11077 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
11078 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
11079 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
11080 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
11081 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
11082 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
11084 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
11093 @cindex terse output
11094 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
11098 The valid @var{format} directives for files with @option{--format} and
11099 @option{--printf} are:
11102 @item %a - Access rights in octal
11103 @item %A - Access rights in human readable form
11104 @item %b - Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
11105 @item %B - The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
11106 @item %C - The SELinux security context of a file, if available
11107 @item %d - Device number in decimal
11108 @item %D - Device number in hex
11109 @item %f - Raw mode in hex
11110 @item %F - File type
11111 @item %g - Group ID of owner
11112 @item %G - Group name of owner
11113 @item %h - Number of hard links
11114 @item %i - Inode number
11115 @item %m - Mount point (See note below)
11116 @item %n - File name
11117 @item %N - Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link
11118 @item %o - Optimal I/O transfer size hint
11119 @item %s - Total size, in bytes
11120 @item %t - Major device type in hex
11121 @item %T - Minor device type in hex
11122 @item %u - User ID of owner
11123 @item %U - User name of owner
11124 @item %w - Time of file birth, or @samp{-} if unknown
11125 @item %W - Time of file birth as seconds since Epoch, or @samp{0}
11126 @item %x - Time of last access
11127 @item %X - Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
11128 @item %y - Time of last modification
11129 @item %Y - Time of last modification as seconds since Epoch
11130 @item %z - Time of last change
11131 @item %Z - Time of last change as seconds since Epoch
11134 The @samp{%W}, @samp{%X}, @samp{%Y}, and @samp{%Z} formats accept a
11135 precision preceded by a period to specify the number of digits to
11136 print after the decimal point. For example, @samp{%.3X} outputs the
11137 last access time to millisecond precision. If a period is given but no
11138 precision, @command{stat} uses 9 digits, so @samp{%.X} is equivalent to
11139 @samp{%.9X}. When discarding excess precision, time stamps are truncated
11140 toward minus infinity.
11144 $ stat -c '[%015Y]' /usr
11147 $ stat -c '[%15Y]' /usr
11149 $ stat -c '[%-15Y]' /usr
11152 $ stat -c '[%.3Y]' /usr
11154 $ stat -c '[%.Y]' /usr
11155 [1288929712.114951834]
11158 The mount point printed by @samp{%m} is similar to that output
11159 by @command{df}, except that:
11162 stat does not dereference symlinks by default
11163 (unless @option{-L} is specified)
11165 stat does not search for specified device nodes in the
11166 file system list, instead operating on them directly
11169 stat outputs the alias for a bind mounted file, rather than
11170 the initial mount point of its backing device.
11171 One can recursively call stat until there is no change in output,
11172 to get the current base mount point
11175 When listing file system information (@option{--file-system} (@option{-f})),
11176 you must use a different set of @var{format} directives:
11179 @item %a - Free blocks available to non-super-user
11180 @item %b - Total data blocks in file system
11181 @item %c - Total file nodes in file system
11182 @item %d - Free file nodes in file system
11183 @item %f - Free blocks in file system
11184 @item %i - File System ID in hex
11185 @item %l - Maximum length of file names
11186 @item %n - File name
11187 @item %s - Block size (for faster transfers)
11188 @item %S - Fundamental block size (for block counts)
11189 @item %t - Type in hex
11190 @item %T - Type in human readable form
11194 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
11195 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
11196 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
11197 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
11202 @node sync invocation
11203 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize data on disk with memory
11206 @cindex synchronize disk and memory
11208 @cindex superblock, writing
11209 @cindex inodes, written buffered
11210 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to disk. This can
11211 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
11212 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
11213 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync} system
11216 @cindex crashes and corruption
11217 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) disk
11218 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
11219 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
11220 result. The @command{sync} command ensures everything in memory
11221 is written to disk.
11223 Any arguments are ignored, except for a lone @option{--help} or
11224 @option{--version} (@pxref{Common options}).
11229 @node truncate invocation
11230 @section @command{truncate}: Shrink or extend the size of a file
11233 @cindex truncating, file sizes
11235 @command{truncate} shrinks or extends the size of each @var{file} to the
11236 specified size. Synopsis:
11239 truncate @var{option}@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
11242 @cindex files, creating
11243 Any @var{file} that does not exist is created.
11245 @cindex sparse files, creating
11246 @cindex holes, creating files with
11247 If a @var{file} is larger than the specified size, the extra data is lost.
11248 If a @var{file} is shorter, it is extended and the extended part (or hole)
11249 reads as zero bytes.
11251 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11258 @opindex --no-create
11259 Do not create files that do not exist.
11264 @opindex --io-blocks
11265 Treat @var{size} as number of I/O blocks of the @var{file} rather than bytes.
11267 @item -r @var{rfile}
11268 @itemx --reference=@var{rfile}
11270 @opindex --reference
11271 Base the size of each @var{file} on the size of @var{rfile}.
11273 @item -s @var{size}
11274 @itemx --size=@var{size}
11277 Set or adjust the size of each @var{file} according to @var{size}.
11278 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
11280 @var{size} may also be prefixed by one of the following to adjust
11281 the size of each @var{file} based on their current size:
11283 @samp{+} => extend by
11284 @samp{-} => reduce by
11285 @samp{<} => at most
11286 @samp{>} => at least
11287 @samp{/} => round down to multiple of
11288 @samp{%} => round up to multiple of
11296 @node Printing text
11297 @chapter Printing text
11299 @cindex printing text, commands for
11300 @cindex commands for printing text
11302 This section describes commands that display text strings.
11305 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
11306 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
11307 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
11311 @node echo invocation
11312 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
11315 @cindex displaying text
11316 @cindex printing text
11317 @cindex text, displaying
11318 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
11320 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
11321 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
11324 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
11327 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{echo}
11329 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11330 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
11331 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
11337 Do not output the trailing newline.
11341 @cindex backslash escapes
11342 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
11351 produce no further output
11367 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
11368 (zero to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
11369 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
11371 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
11372 (one to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
11373 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
11375 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
11376 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
11381 @cindex backslash escapes
11382 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
11383 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
11384 specified, the last one given takes effect.
11388 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
11389 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
11390 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
11391 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
11392 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
11393 plain @samp{hello}.
11395 @acronym{POSIX} does not require support for any options, and says
11396 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
11397 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is
11398 @option{-n}. Portable programs can use the @command{printf} command
11399 if they need to omit trailing newlines or output control characters or
11400 backslashes. @xref{printf invocation}.
11405 @node printf invocation
11406 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
11409 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
11412 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
11415 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
11416 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
11417 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function.
11418 @xref{Output Conversion Syntax,, @command{printf} format directives,
11419 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for details.
11420 The differences are listed below.
11422 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{printf}
11427 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
11428 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
11432 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
11433 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
11434 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
11438 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
11439 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
11440 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
11443 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
11444 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
11445 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
11446 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
11451 @command{printf} has an additional directive, @samp{%b}, which prints its
11452 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
11453 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
11454 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits. If
11455 @samp{\@var{ooo}} is nine-bit value, ignore the ninth bit.
11456 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
11457 from the converted string.
11460 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
11461 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
11465 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
11466 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
11467 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
11468 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
11469 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
11470 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
11471 @samp{97} on hosts that use the @acronym{ASCII} character set, since
11472 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in @acronym{ASCII}.
11477 A floating-point argument must use a period before any fractional
11478 digits, but is printed according to the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of the
11479 current locale. For example, in a locale whose radix character is a
11480 comma, the command @samp{printf %g 3.14} outputs @samp{3,14} whereas
11481 the command @samp{printf %g 3,14} is an error.
11482 @xref{Floating point}.
11486 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
11487 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a byte to print,
11488 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
11489 digits) specifying a character to print.
11490 Note however that when @samp{\@var{ooo}} specifies a number larger than 255,
11491 @command{printf} ignores the ninth bit.
11492 For example, @samp{printf '\400'} is equivalent to @samp{printf '\0'}.
11497 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
11499 @command{printf} interprets two character syntaxes introduced in
11500 @acronym{ISO} C 99:
11501 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode (@acronym{ISO}/@acronym{IEC} 10646)
11502 characters, specified as
11503 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
11504 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
11505 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
11506 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale. Unicode characters in the ranges
11507 U+0000...U+009F, U+D800...U+DFFF cannot be specified by this syntax, except
11508 for U+0024 ($), U+0040 (@@), and U+0060 (@`).
11510 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
11511 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
11512 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
11513 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
11515 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
11516 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
11517 Options must precede operands.
11519 The Unicode character syntaxes are useful for writing strings in a locale
11520 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
11523 $ env printf '\u20AC 14.95'
11527 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
11528 (@acronym{ISO}-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
11531 $ env printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
11535 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
11537 Note that in these examples, the @command{printf} command has been
11538 invoked via @command{env} to ensure that we run the program found via
11539 your shell's search path, and not a shell alias or a built-in function.
11541 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
11542 values of each character one by one. @acronym{ASCII} characters mixed with \u
11543 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
11544 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
11545 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
11546 this text in a locale-independent way:
11549 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_CN.big5 /usr/local/bin/printf \
11550 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
11551 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
11552 | sed -e "s|^|/usr/local/bin/printf '|" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
11559 @node yes invocation
11560 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
11563 @cindex repeated output of a string
11565 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
11566 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
11567 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
11569 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
11571 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
11572 To output an argument that begins with
11573 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
11574 @xref{Common options}.
11578 @chapter Conditions
11581 @cindex commands for exit status
11582 @cindex exit status commands
11584 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
11585 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
11586 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
11590 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
11591 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
11592 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
11593 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
11597 @node false invocation
11598 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
11601 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
11602 @cindex failure exit status
11603 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
11605 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
11606 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
11607 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
11608 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
11609 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
11610 command, not the one documented here.
11612 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
11614 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
11615 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
11616 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
11618 Note that @command{false} (unlike all other programs documented herein)
11619 exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
11620 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
11622 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
11623 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
11624 non-@acronym{GNU} hosts.
11627 @node true invocation
11628 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
11631 @cindex do nothing, successfully
11633 @cindex successful exit
11634 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
11636 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
11637 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
11638 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
11639 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
11640 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
11641 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
11642 command, not the one documented here.
11644 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
11646 Note, however, that it is possible to cause @command{true}
11647 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
11648 option, and with standard
11649 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
11650 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
11653 $ ./true --version >&-
11654 ./true: write error: Bad file number
11655 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
11656 ./true: write error: No space left on device
11659 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
11660 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
11661 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
11663 @node test invocation
11664 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
11667 @cindex check file types
11668 @cindex compare values
11669 @cindex expression evaluation
11671 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
11672 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
11673 expression must be a separate argument.
11675 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
11676 comparison operators.
11678 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
11679 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
11680 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
11681 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
11682 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
11683 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
11689 test @var{expression}
11691 [ @var{expression} ]
11696 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{test}
11698 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
11699 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
11700 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true
11701 otherwise. The argument
11702 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
11703 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
11704 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
11705 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
11706 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
11708 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
11712 0 if the expression is true,
11713 1 if the expression is false,
11714 2 if an error occurred.
11718 * File type tests:: -[bcdfhLpSt]
11719 * Access permission tests:: -[gkruwxOG]
11720 * File characteristic tests:: -e -s -nt -ot -ef
11721 * String tests:: -z -n = == !=
11722 * Numeric tests:: -eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge
11723 * Connectives for test:: ! -a -o
11727 @node File type tests
11728 @subsection File type tests
11730 @cindex file type tests
11732 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
11733 but not all files are the same!)
11737 @item -b @var{file}
11739 @cindex block special check
11740 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
11742 @item -c @var{file}
11744 @cindex character special check
11745 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
11747 @item -d @var{file}
11749 @cindex directory check
11750 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
11752 @item -f @var{file}
11754 @cindex regular file check
11755 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
11757 @item -h @var{file}
11758 @itemx -L @var{file}
11761 @cindex symbolic link check
11762 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
11763 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
11764 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
11766 @item -p @var{file}
11768 @cindex named pipe check
11769 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
11771 @item -S @var{file}
11773 @cindex socket check
11774 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
11778 @cindex terminal check
11779 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
11785 @node Access permission tests
11786 @subsection Access permission tests
11788 @cindex access permission tests
11789 @cindex permission tests
11791 These options test for particular access permissions.
11795 @item -g @var{file}
11797 @cindex set-group-ID check
11798 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
11800 @item -k @var{file}
11802 @cindex sticky bit check
11803 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
11805 @item -r @var{file}
11807 @cindex readable file check
11808 True if @var{file} exists and read permission is granted.
11810 @item -u @var{file}
11812 @cindex set-user-ID check
11813 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
11815 @item -w @var{file}
11817 @cindex writable file check
11818 True if @var{file} exists and write permission is granted.
11820 @item -x @var{file}
11822 @cindex executable file check
11823 True if @var{file} exists and execute permission is granted
11824 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
11826 @item -O @var{file}
11828 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
11829 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
11831 @item -G @var{file}
11833 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
11834 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
11838 @node File characteristic tests
11839 @subsection File characteristic tests
11841 @cindex file characteristic tests
11843 These options test other file characteristics.
11847 @item -e @var{file}
11849 @cindex existence-of-file check
11850 True if @var{file} exists.
11852 @item -s @var{file}
11854 @cindex nonempty file check
11855 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
11857 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
11859 @cindex newer-than file check
11860 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
11861 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
11863 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
11865 @cindex older-than file check
11866 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
11867 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
11869 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
11871 @cindex same file check
11872 @cindex hard link check
11873 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
11874 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
11880 @subsection String tests
11882 @cindex string tests
11884 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
11885 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
11891 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
11892 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
11896 @item -z @var{string}
11898 @cindex zero-length string check
11899 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
11901 @item -n @var{string}
11902 @itemx @var{string}
11904 @cindex nonzero-length string check
11905 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
11907 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
11909 @cindex equal string check
11910 True if the strings are equal.
11912 @item @var{string1} == @var{string2}
11914 @cindex equal string check
11915 True if the strings are equal (synonym for =).
11917 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
11919 @cindex not-equal string check
11920 True if the strings are not equal.
11925 @node Numeric tests
11926 @subsection Numeric tests
11928 @cindex numeric tests
11929 @cindex arithmetic tests
11931 Numeric relational operators. The arguments must be entirely numeric
11932 (possibly negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}},
11933 which evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
11937 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
11938 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
11939 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
11940 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
11941 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
11942 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
11949 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
11950 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
11951 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
11958 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
11960 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
11963 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
11967 @node Connectives for test
11968 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
11970 @cindex logical connectives
11971 @cindex connectives, logical
11973 The usual logical connectives.
11979 True if @var{expr} is false.
11981 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
11983 @cindex logical and operator
11984 @cindex and operator
11985 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
11987 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
11989 @cindex logical or operator
11990 @cindex or operator
11991 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
11996 @node expr invocation
11997 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
12000 @cindex expression evaluation
12001 @cindex evaluation of expressions
12003 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
12004 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
12006 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
12007 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
12008 @command{expr} converts
12009 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
12010 depending on the operation being applied to it.
12012 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
12013 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
12014 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
12015 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
12016 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
12017 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
12018 work around this is to use the @sc{gnu} extension @code{+},
12019 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
12020 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
12021 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
12023 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
12024 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
12025 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
12026 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
12027 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
12028 leading spaces as mentioned above.
12030 @cindex parentheses for grouping
12031 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
12032 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
12033 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
12036 When built with support for the GNU MP library, @command{expr} uses
12037 arbitrary-precision arithmetic; otherwise, it uses native arithmetic
12038 types and may fail due to arithmetic overflow.
12040 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12041 options}. Options must precede operands.
12043 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
12047 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
12048 1 if the expression is null or 0,
12049 2 if the expression is invalid,
12050 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
12054 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
12055 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
12056 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
12057 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
12061 @node String expressions
12062 @subsection String expressions
12064 @cindex string expressions
12065 @cindex expressions, string
12067 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
12068 have higher precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
12069 the next sections).
12073 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
12074 @cindex pattern matching
12075 @cindex regular expression matching
12076 @cindex matching patterns
12077 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
12078 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
12079 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
12080 then matched against this regular expression.
12082 If the match succeeds and @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the
12083 @code{:} expression returns the part of @var{string} that matched the
12084 subexpression; otherwise, it returns the number of characters matched.
12086 If the match fails, the @code{:} operator returns the null string if
12087 @samp{\(} and @samp{\)} are used in @var{regex}, otherwise 0.
12089 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
12090 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
12091 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
12092 expression operators.
12094 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
12095 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
12096 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
12097 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
12098 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
12099 alternatives. SunOS and other @command{expr}'s treat these as regular
12100 characters. (@acronym{POSIX} allows either behavior.)
12101 @xref{Top, , Regular Expression Library, regex, Regex}, for details of
12102 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
12104 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
12106 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
12107 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
12109 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
12111 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
12112 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
12113 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
12115 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
12117 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
12118 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
12119 @var{string}, return 0.
12121 @item length @var{string}
12123 Returns the length of @var{string}.
12125 @item + @var{token}
12127 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
12128 or an operator like @code{/}.
12129 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
12130 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
12131 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
12132 This operator is a @acronym{GNU} extension. Portable shell scripts should use
12133 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
12137 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
12138 @code{quote} operator.
12141 @node Numeric expressions
12142 @subsection Numeric expressions
12144 @cindex numeric expressions
12145 @cindex expressions, numeric
12147 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
12148 precedence. These numeric operators have lower precedence than the
12149 string operators described in the previous section, and higher precedence
12150 than the connectives (next section).
12158 @cindex subtraction
12159 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
12160 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
12166 @cindex multiplication
12169 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
12170 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
12175 @node Relations for expr
12176 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
12178 @cindex connectives, logical
12179 @cindex logical connectives
12180 @cindex relations, numeric or string
12182 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
12183 have lower precedence than the string and numeric operators
12184 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
12190 @cindex logical or operator
12191 @cindex or operator
12192 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
12193 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
12194 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
12199 @cindex logical and operator
12200 @cindex and operator
12201 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
12202 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
12205 @item < <= = == != >= >
12212 @cindex comparison operators
12214 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
12215 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
12216 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
12217 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
12218 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
12223 @node Examples of expr
12224 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
12226 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
12227 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
12229 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
12232 foo=$(expr $foo + 1)
12235 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
12236 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
12239 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
12242 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
12250 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
12252 expr index abcdef cz
12255 @error{} expr: syntax error
12256 expr index + index a
12262 @chapter Redirection
12264 @cindex redirection
12265 @cindex commands for redirection
12267 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection}---ways
12268 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
12269 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
12270 it's described here.
12273 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes.
12277 @node tee invocation
12278 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
12281 @cindex pipe fitting
12282 @cindex destinations, multiple output
12283 @cindex read from stdin and write to stdout and files
12285 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
12286 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
12287 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
12290 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12293 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
12294 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
12295 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
12297 A @var{file} of @samp{-} causes @command{tee} to send another copy of
12298 input to standard output, but this is typically not that useful as the
12299 copies are interleaved.
12301 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12308 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
12312 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
12314 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
12315 Ignore interrupt signals.
12319 The @command{tee} command is useful when you happen to be transferring a large
12320 amount of data and also want to summarize that data without reading
12321 it a second time. For example, when you are downloading a DVD image,
12322 you often want to verify its signature or checksum right away.
12323 The inefficient way to do it is simply:
12326 wget http://example.com/some.iso && sha1sum some.iso
12329 One problem with the above is that it makes you wait for the
12330 download to complete before starting the time-consuming SHA1 computation.
12331 Perhaps even more importantly, the above requires reading
12332 the DVD image a second time (the first was from the network).
12334 The efficient way to do it is to interleave the download
12335 and SHA1 computation. Then, you'll get the checksum for
12336 free, because the entire process parallelizes so well:
12339 # slightly contrived, to demonstrate process substitution
12340 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
12341 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) > dvd.iso
12344 That makes @command{tee} write not just to the expected output file,
12345 but also to a pipe running @command{sha1sum} and saving the final
12346 checksum in a file named @file{dvd.sha1}.
12348 Note, however, that this example relies on a feature of modern shells
12349 called @dfn{process substitution}
12350 (the @samp{>(command)} syntax, above;
12351 @xref{Process Substitution,,Process Substitution, bashref,
12352 The Bash Reference Manual}.),
12353 so it works with @command{zsh}, @command{bash}, and @command{ksh},
12354 but not with @command{/bin/sh}. So if you write code like this
12355 in a shell script, be sure to start the script with @samp{#!/bin/bash}.
12357 Since the above example writes to one file and one process,
12358 a more conventional and portable use of @command{tee} is even better:
12361 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
12362 | tee dvd.iso | sha1sum > dvd.sha1
12365 You can extend this example to make @command{tee} write to two processes,
12366 computing MD5 and SHA1 checksums in parallel. In this case,
12367 process substitution is required:
12370 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
12371 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) \
12372 >(md5sum > dvd.md5) \
12376 This technique is also useful when you want to make a @emph{compressed}
12377 copy of the contents of a pipe.
12378 Consider a tool to graphically summarize disk usage data from @samp{du -ak}.
12379 For a large hierarchy, @samp{du -ak} can run for a long time,
12380 and can easily produce terabytes of data, so you won't want to
12381 rerun the command unnecessarily. Nor will you want to save
12382 the uncompressed output.
12384 Doing it the inefficient way, you can't even start the GUI
12385 until after you've compressed all of the @command{du} output:
12388 du -ak | gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz
12389 gzip -d /tmp/du.gz | xdiskusage -a
12392 With @command{tee} and process substitution, you start the GUI
12393 right away and eliminate the decompression completely:
12396 du -ak | tee >(gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz) | xdiskusage -a
12399 Finally, if you regularly create more than one type of
12400 compressed tarball at once, for example when @code{make dist} creates
12401 both @command{gzip}-compressed and @command{bzip2}-compressed tarballs,
12402 there may be a better way.
12403 Typical @command{automake}-generated @file{Makefile} rules create
12404 the two compressed tar archives with commands in sequence, like this
12405 (slightly simplified):
12408 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
12409 tar chof - "$tardir" | gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz
12410 tar chof - "$tardir" | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
12413 However, if the hierarchy you are archiving and compressing is larger
12414 than a couple megabytes, and especially if you are using a multi-processor
12415 system with plenty of memory, then you can do much better by reading the
12416 directory contents only once and running the compression programs in parallel:
12419 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
12420 tar chof - "$tardir" \
12421 | tee >(gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz) \
12422 | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
12428 @node File name manipulation
12429 @chapter File name manipulation
12431 @cindex file name manipulation
12432 @cindex manipulation of file names
12433 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
12435 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
12438 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
12439 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component.
12440 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability.
12441 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory.
12442 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names.
12446 @node basename invocation
12447 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
12450 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
12451 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
12452 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
12453 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
12454 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
12456 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
12457 @var{name}. Synopsis:
12460 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
12461 basename @var{option}... @var{name}...
12464 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
12465 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Note that since trailing slashes
12466 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
12467 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
12470 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
12471 @macro basenameAndDirname
12472 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
12473 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
12474 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
12475 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
12477 @basenameAndDirname
12479 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
12480 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, @acronym{GNU}
12481 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
12482 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
12483 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
12485 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12486 Options must precede operands.
12493 @opindex --multiple
12494 Support more than one argument. Treat every argument as a @var{name}.
12495 With this, an optional @var{suffix} must be specified using the
12496 @option{-s} option.
12498 @item -s @var{suffix}
12499 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
12502 Remove a trailing @var{suffix}.
12503 This option implies the @option{-a} option.
12509 Separate output items with @sc{nul} characters.
12519 basename /usr/bin/sort
12522 basename include/stdio.h .h
12525 basename -s .h include/stdio.h
12527 # Output "stdio" followed by "stdlib"
12528 basename -a -s .h include/stdio.h include/stdlib.h
12532 @node dirname invocation
12533 @section @command{dirname}: Strip last file name component
12536 @cindex directory components, printing
12537 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
12538 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
12540 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component
12541 of each @var{name}. Slashes on either side of the final component are
12542 also removed. If the string contains no slash, @command{dirname}
12543 prints @samp{.} (meaning the current directory). Synopsis:
12546 dirname [@var{option}] @var{name}...
12549 @var{name} need not be a file name, but if it is, this operation
12550 effectively lists the directory that contains the final component,
12551 including the case when the final component is itself a directory.
12553 @basenameAndDirname
12555 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
12556 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With @acronym{GNU} @command{dirname}, the
12557 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
12558 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
12560 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12568 Separate output items with @sc{nul} characters.
12577 # Output "/usr/bin".
12578 dirname /usr/bin/sort
12579 dirname /usr/bin//.//
12581 # Output "dir1" followed by "dir2"
12582 dirname dir1/str dir2/str
12589 @node pathchk invocation
12590 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name validity and portability
12593 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
12594 @cindex valid file names, checking for
12595 @cindex portable file names, checking for
12597 @command{pathchk} checks validity and portability of file names. Synopsis:
12600 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
12603 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints an error message if any of
12604 these conditions is true:
12608 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
12609 (execute) permission,
12611 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
12614 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
12615 its file system's maximum.
12618 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long a file with that
12619 name could be created under the above conditions.
12621 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12622 Options must precede operands.
12628 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
12629 print an error message if any of these conditions is true:
12633 A file name is empty.
12636 A file name contains a character outside the @acronym{POSIX} portable file
12637 name character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{.},
12638 @samp{_}, @samp{-}, and @samp{/}.
12641 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
12642 @acronym{POSIX} minimum limits for portability.
12647 Print an error message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
12648 that begins with @samp{-}.
12650 @item --portability
12651 @opindex --portability
12652 Print an error message if a file name is not portable to all @acronym{POSIX}
12653 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
12657 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
12661 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
12665 @node mktemp invocation
12666 @section @command{mktemp}: Create temporary file or directory
12669 @cindex file names, creating temporary
12670 @cindex directory, creating temporary
12671 @cindex temporary files and directories
12673 @command{mktemp} manages the creation of temporary files and
12674 directories. Synopsis:
12677 mktemp [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{template}]
12680 Safely create a temporary file or directory based on @var{template},
12681 and print its name. If given, @var{template} must include at least
12682 three consecutive @samp{X}s in the last component. If omitted, the template
12683 @samp{tmp.XXXXXXXXXX} is used, and option @option{--tmpdir} is
12684 implied. The final run of @samp{X}s in the @var{template} will be replaced
12685 by alpha-numeric characters; thus, on a case-sensitive file system,
12686 and with a @var{template} including a run of @var{n} instances of @samp{X},
12687 there are @samp{62**@var{n}} potential file names.
12689 Older scripts used to create temporary files by simply joining the
12690 name of the program with the process id (@samp{$$}) as a suffix.
12691 However, that naming scheme is easily predictable, and suffers from a
12692 race condition where the attacker can create an appropriately named
12693 symbolic link, such that when the script then opens a handle to what
12694 it thought was an unused file, it is instead modifying an existing
12695 file. Using the same scheme to create a directory is slightly safer,
12696 since the @command{mkdir} will fail if the target already exists, but
12697 it is still inferior because it allows for denial of service attacks.
12698 Therefore, modern scripts should use the @command{mktemp} command to
12699 guarantee that the generated name will be unpredictable, and that
12700 knowledge of the temporary file name implies that the file was created
12701 by the current script and cannot be modified by other users.
12703 When creating a file, the resulting file has read and write
12704 permissions for the current user, but no permissions for the group or
12705 others; these permissions are reduced if the current umask is more
12708 Here are some examples (although note that if you repeat them, you
12709 will most likely get different file names):
12714 Create a temporary file in the current directory.
12721 Create a temporary file with a known suffix.
12723 $ mktemp --suffix=.txt file-XXXX
12725 $ mktemp file-XXXX-XXXX.txt
12730 Create a secure fifo relative to the user's choice of @env{TMPDIR},
12731 but falling back to the current directory rather than @file{/tmp}.
12732 Note that @command{mktemp} does not create fifos, but can create a
12733 secure directory in which the fifo can live. Exit the shell if the
12734 directory or fifo could not be created.
12736 $ dir=$(mktemp -p "$@{TMPDIR:-.@}" -d dir-XXXX) || exit 1
12738 $ mkfifo "$fifo" || @{ rmdir "$dir"; exit 1; @}
12742 Create and use a temporary file if possible, but ignore failure. The
12743 file will reside in the directory named by @env{TMPDIR}, if specified,
12744 or else in @file{/tmp}.
12746 $ file=$(mktemp -q) && @{
12747 > # Safe to use $file only within this block. Use quotes,
12748 > # since $TMPDIR, and thus $file, may contain whitespace.
12749 > echo ... > "$file"
12755 Act as a semi-random character generator (it is not fully random,
12756 since it is impacted by the contents of the current directory). To
12757 avoid security holes, do not use the resulting names to create a file.
12767 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12774 @opindex --directory
12775 Create a directory rather than a file. The directory will have read,
12776 write, and search permissions for the current user, but no permissions
12777 for the group or others; these permissions are reduced if the current
12778 umask is more restrictive.
12784 Suppress diagnostics about failure to create a file or directory. The
12785 exit status will still reflect whether a file was created.
12791 Generate a temporary name that does not name an existing file, without
12792 changing the file system contents. Using the output of this command
12793 to create a new file is inherently unsafe, as there is a window of
12794 time between generating the name and using it where another process
12795 can create an object by the same name.
12798 @itemx --tmpdir[=@var{dir}]
12801 Treat @var{template} relative to the directory @var{dir}. If
12802 @var{dir} is not specified (only possible with the long option
12803 @option{--tmpdir}) or is the empty string, use the value of
12804 @env{TMPDIR} if available, otherwise use @samp{/tmp}. If this is
12805 specified, @var{template} must not be absolute. However,
12806 @var{template} can still contain slashes, although intermediate
12807 directories must already exist.
12809 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
12811 Append @var{suffix} to the @var{template}. @var{suffix} must not
12812 contain slash. If @option{--suffix} is specified, @var{template} must
12813 end in @samp{X}; if it is not specified, then an appropriate
12814 @option{--suffix} is inferred by finding the last @samp{X} in
12815 @var{template}. This option exists for use with the default
12816 @var{template} and for the creation of a @var{suffix} that starts with
12821 Treat @var{template} as a single file relative to the value of
12822 @env{TMPDIR} if available, or to the directory specified by
12823 @option{-p}, otherwise to @samp{/tmp}. @var{template} must not
12824 contain slashes. This option is deprecated; the use of @option{-p}
12825 without @option{-t} offers better defaults (by favoring the command
12826 line over @env{TMPDIR}) and more flexibility (by allowing intermediate
12831 @cindex exit status of @command{mktemp}
12835 0 if the file was created,
12840 @node realpath invocation
12841 @section @command{realpath}: Print the resolved file name.
12844 @cindex file names, canonicalization
12845 @cindex symlinks, resolution
12846 @cindex canonical file name
12847 @cindex canonicalize a file name
12851 @command{realpath} expands all symbolic links and resolves references to
12852 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and extra @samp{/} characters. By default,
12853 all but the last component of the specified files must exist. Synopsis:
12856 realpath [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
12859 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12864 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
12866 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
12867 Ensure that all components of the specified file names exist.
12868 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{realpath} will output
12869 a diagnostic unless the @option{-q} option is specified, and exit with a
12870 nonzero exit code. A trailing slash requires that the name resolve to a
12874 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
12876 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
12877 If any component of a specified file name is missing or unavailable,
12878 treat it as a directory.
12884 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
12885 but they are resolved after any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
12890 @opindex --physical
12891 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
12892 and they are resolved before any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
12893 This is the default mode of operation.
12899 Suppress diagnostic messages for specified file names.
12903 @itemx --no-symlinks
12906 @opindex --no-symlinks
12907 Do not resolve symbolic links. Only resolve references to
12908 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and remove extra @samp{/} characters.
12909 When combined with the @option{-m} option, realpath operates
12910 only on the file name, and does not touch any actual file.
12916 Separate output items with @sc{nul} characters.
12918 @itemx --relative-to=@var{file}
12919 @opindex --relative-to
12921 Print the resolved file names relative to the specified file.
12922 Note this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e} options
12923 pertaining to file existence.
12925 @itemx --relative-base=@var{base}
12926 @opindex --relative-base
12927 This option is valid when used with @option{--relative-to}, and will restrict
12928 the output of @option{--relative-to} so that relative names are output,
12929 only when @var{file}s are descendants of @var{base}. Otherwise output the
12930 absolute file name. If @option{--relative-to} was not specified, then
12931 the descendants of @var{base} are printed relative to @var{base}. If
12932 @option{--relative-to} is specified, then that directory must be a
12933 descendant of @var{base} for this option to have an effect.
12934 Note: this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e}
12935 options pertaining to file existence. For example:
12938 realpath --relative-to=/usr /tmp /usr/bin
12941 realpath --relative-base=/usr /tmp /usr/bin
12948 @cindex exit status of @command{realpath}
12952 0 if all file names were printed without issue.
12957 @node Working context
12958 @chapter Working context
12960 @cindex working context
12961 @cindex commands for printing the working context
12963 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
12964 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
12965 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
12968 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
12969 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
12970 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
12971 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
12975 @node pwd invocation
12976 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
12979 @cindex print name of current directory
12980 @cindex current working directory, printing
12981 @cindex working directory, printing
12984 @command{pwd} prints the name of the current directory. Synopsis:
12987 pwd [@var{option}]@dots{}
12990 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12997 If the contents of the environment variable @env{PWD} provide an
12998 absolute name of the current directory with no @samp{.} or @samp{..}
12999 components, but possibly with symbolic links, then output those
13000 contents. Otherwise, fall back to default @option{-P} handling.
13005 @opindex --physical
13006 Print a fully resolved name for the current directory. That is, all
13007 components of the printed name will be actual directory names---none
13008 will be symbolic links.
13011 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
13012 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
13013 precedence. If neither option is given, then this implementation uses
13014 @option{-P} as the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
13015 environment variable is set.
13017 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{pwd}
13022 @node stty invocation
13023 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
13026 @cindex change or print terminal settings
13027 @cindex terminal settings
13028 @cindex line settings of terminal
13030 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
13034 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
13035 stty [@var{option}]
13038 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
13039 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
13040 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
13041 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
13042 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
13043 @option{--file} option.
13045 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
13046 the terminal line operation, as described below.
13048 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13055 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
13056 be used in combination with any line settings.
13058 @item -F @var{device}
13059 @itemx --file=@var{device}
13062 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
13063 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
13064 because opening a @acronym{POSIX} tty requires use of the
13065 @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to prevent a @acronym{POSIX} tty from blocking
13066 until the carrier detect line is high if
13067 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
13068 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
13074 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
13075 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
13076 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
13077 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
13081 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
13082 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
13083 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
13084 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
13087 Some settings are not available on all @acronym{POSIX} systems, since they use
13088 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with
13089 ``Non-@acronym{POSIX}'' in their description. On non-@acronym{POSIX}
13090 systems, those or other settings also may not
13091 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
13097 * Control:: Control settings
13098 * Input:: Input settings
13099 * Output:: Output settings
13100 * Local:: Local settings
13101 * Combination:: Combination settings
13102 * Characters:: Special characters
13103 * Special:: Special settings
13108 @subsection Control settings
13110 @cindex control settings
13116 @cindex two-way parity
13117 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
13123 @cindex even parity
13124 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
13131 @cindex character size
13132 @cindex eight-bit characters
13133 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
13138 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
13144 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
13148 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
13152 @cindex modem control
13153 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
13157 @cindex hardware flow control
13158 @cindex flow control, hardware
13159 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
13160 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
13165 @subsection Input settings
13167 @cindex input settings
13168 These settings control operations on data received from the terminal.
13173 @cindex breaks, ignoring
13174 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
13178 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
13179 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
13183 @cindex parity, ignoring
13184 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
13188 @cindex parity errors, marking
13189 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
13193 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
13197 @cindex eight-bit input
13198 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
13202 @cindex newline, translating to return
13203 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
13207 @cindex return, ignoring
13208 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
13212 @cindex return, translating to newline
13213 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
13217 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
13218 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
13222 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
13223 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
13224 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{CTRL-S}/@kbd{CTRL-Q}). May
13231 @cindex software flow control
13232 @cindex flow control, software
13233 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
13234 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
13235 empty again. May be negated.
13239 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
13240 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
13241 negated. Note ilcuc is not implemented, as one would not be able to issue
13242 almost any (lowercase) Unix command, after invoking it.
13246 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
13247 if negated). Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
13251 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
13252 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
13253 when the input buffer is full. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
13258 @subsection Output settings
13260 @cindex output settings
13261 These settings control operations on data sent to the terminal.
13266 Postprocess output. May be negated.
13270 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
13271 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
13272 negated. (Note ouclc is not currently implemented.)
13276 @cindex return, translating to newline
13277 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
13281 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
13282 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
13287 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13292 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
13296 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
13297 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays.
13298 Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13303 @cindex pad character
13304 Use @acronym{ASCII} @sc{del} characters for fill instead of
13305 @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} characters. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13311 Newline delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13318 Carriage return delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13324 @opindex tab@var{n}
13325 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13330 Backspace delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13335 Vertical tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13340 Form feed delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13345 @subsection Local settings
13347 @cindex local settings
13352 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
13353 characters. May be negated.
13357 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
13358 special characters. May be negated.
13362 Enable non-@acronym{POSIX} special characters. May be negated.
13366 Echo input characters. May be negated.
13372 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
13377 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
13378 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
13382 @cindex newline, echoing
13383 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
13387 @cindex flushing, disabling
13388 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
13389 characters. May be negated.
13393 @cindex case translation
13394 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
13395 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
13396 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
13400 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
13401 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13408 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
13409 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
13415 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
13416 @cindex hat notation for control characters
13417 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
13418 of literally. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
13424 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
13425 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
13426 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings.
13427 Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13433 @subsection Combination settings
13435 @cindex combination settings
13436 Combination settings:
13443 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
13444 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
13448 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
13449 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
13453 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
13454 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
13458 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
13465 @c This is too long to write inline.
13467 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl -ixoff
13468 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel opost -olcuc -ocrnl onlcr
13469 -onocr -onlret -ofill -ofdel nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0
13470 ff0 isig icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl
13471 -noflsh -xcase -tostop -echoprt echoctl echoke
13475 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
13479 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
13480 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
13481 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
13482 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
13489 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
13490 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -iuclc -ixany
13491 -imaxbel -opost -isig -icanon -xcase min 1 time 0
13495 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
13499 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
13504 @cindex eight-bit characters
13505 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
13506 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
13510 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
13511 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
13515 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
13519 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated. If negated, same
13526 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
13527 (Used for terminals with uppercase characters only.)
13531 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
13535 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
13540 @subsection Special characters
13542 @cindex special characters
13543 @cindex characters, special
13545 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
13546 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
13547 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
13548 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
13549 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
13550 any other digit to indicate decimal.
13552 @cindex disabling special characters
13553 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
13554 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
13555 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
13556 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
13557 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
13558 special character to @key{U}.)
13564 Send an interrupt signal.
13568 Send a quit signal.
13572 Erase the last character typed.
13576 Erase the current line.
13580 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
13588 Alternate character to end the line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13592 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13596 Restart the output after stopping it.
13604 Send a terminal stop signal.
13608 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13612 Redraw the current line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13616 Erase the last word typed. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13620 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
13621 character. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13626 @subsection Special settings
13628 @cindex special settings
13633 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
13634 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
13638 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
13639 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
13641 @item ispeed @var{n}
13643 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
13645 @item ospeed @var{n}
13647 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
13651 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows.
13652 Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13655 @itemx columns @var{n}
13658 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13664 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
13665 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
13666 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
13667 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
13668 Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13672 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
13676 Print the terminal speed.
13679 @cindex baud rate, setting
13680 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one of: 0
13681 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600 19200
13682 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as 19200;
13683 @code{extb} is the same as 38400. Many systems, including GNU/Linux,
13684 support higher speeds. The @command{stty} command includes support
13701 4000000 where the system supports these.
13702 0 hangs up the line if @option{-clocal} is set.
13706 @node printenv invocation
13707 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
13710 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
13711 @cindex environment variables, printing
13713 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
13716 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
13719 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
13720 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
13721 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
13723 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13731 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
13735 0 if all variables specified were found
13736 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
13737 2 if a write error occurred
13741 @node tty invocation
13742 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
13745 @cindex print terminal file name
13746 @cindex terminal file name, printing
13748 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
13749 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
13753 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
13756 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13766 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
13770 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
13774 0 if standard input is a terminal
13775 1 if standard input is not a terminal
13776 2 if given incorrect arguments
13777 3 if a write error occurs
13781 @node User information
13782 @chapter User information
13784 @cindex user information, commands for
13785 @cindex commands for printing user information
13787 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
13788 logins, groups, and so forth.
13791 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
13792 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
13793 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
13794 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
13795 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
13796 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
13800 @node id invocation
13801 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
13804 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
13805 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
13806 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
13808 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
13809 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
13812 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{username}]
13815 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
13816 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
13817 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
13818 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
13819 In addition, if SELinux
13820 is enabled and the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is not set,
13821 then print @samp{context=@var{c}}, where @var{c} is the security context.
13823 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
13824 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
13826 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
13827 Also see @ref{Common options}.
13834 Print only the group ID.
13840 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
13846 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
13847 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
13853 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID. Requires
13854 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
13860 Print only the user ID.
13867 @cindex security context
13868 Print only the security context of the current user.
13869 If SELinux is disabled then print a warning and
13870 set the exit status to 1.
13876 @macro primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{cmd,arg}
13877 Primary and supplementary groups for a process are normally inherited
13878 from its parent and are usually unchanged since login. This means
13879 that if you change the group database after logging in, @command{\cmd\}
13880 will not reflect your changes within your existing login session.
13881 Running @command{\cmd\} with a \arg\ causes the user and group
13882 database to be consulted afresh, and so will give a different result.
13884 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{id,user argument}
13886 @node logname invocation
13887 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
13890 @cindex printing user's login name
13891 @cindex login name, printing
13892 @cindex user name, printing
13895 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
13896 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
13897 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
13898 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
13899 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
13901 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13907 @node whoami invocation
13908 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user ID
13911 @cindex effective user ID, printing
13912 @cindex printing the effective user ID
13914 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
13915 effective user ID. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
13917 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13923 @node groups invocation
13924 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
13927 @cindex printing groups a user is in
13928 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
13930 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
13931 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
13932 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
13934 the list of that user's groups and the user name is separated from the
13935 group list by a colon. Synopsis:
13938 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
13941 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
13943 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{groups,list of users}
13945 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13951 @node users invocation
13952 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
13955 @cindex printing current usernames
13956 @cindex usernames, printing current
13958 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
13959 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
13960 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
13961 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
13962 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
13971 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
13972 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
13973 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
13974 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
13976 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13982 @node who invocation
13983 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
13986 @cindex printing current user information
13987 @cindex information, about current users
13989 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
13993 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
13996 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
13998 @cindex remote hostname
13999 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
14000 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
14001 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
14005 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
14006 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
14007 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
14008 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
14009 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
14013 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
14014 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
14015 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
14016 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
14019 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
14020 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
14021 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
14022 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
14024 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14032 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
14038 Print the date and time of last system boot.
14044 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
14050 Print a line of column headings.
14056 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
14057 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
14061 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
14062 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
14063 automatic dial-up internet access.
14067 Same as @samp{who am i}.
14073 List active processes spawned by init.
14079 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
14080 Overrides all other options.
14085 @opindex --runlevel
14086 Print the current (and maybe previous) run-level of the init process.
14090 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
14096 Print last system clock change.
14101 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
14102 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
14103 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
14114 @opindex --writable
14115 @cindex message status
14116 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
14117 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
14120 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
14121 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
14122 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
14130 @node System context
14131 @chapter System context
14133 @cindex system context
14134 @cindex context, system
14135 @cindex commands for system context
14137 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
14141 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
14142 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name.
14143 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors.
14144 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
14145 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
14146 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
14147 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load.
14150 @node date invocation
14151 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
14154 @cindex time, printing or setting
14155 @cindex printing the current time
14160 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
14161 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
14162 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
14166 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
14167 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
14168 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
14169 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 13:47:51 PST 2005}.
14172 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
14173 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
14174 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
14175 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
14177 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
14178 @cindex time formats
14179 @cindex formatting times
14180 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
14181 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
14182 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
14183 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
14184 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
14185 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
14191 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
14192 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
14193 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
14194 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
14195 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
14196 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
14198 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
14200 * Examples of date:: Examples.
14203 @node Time conversion specifiers
14204 @subsection Time conversion specifiers
14206 @cindex time conversion specifiers
14207 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
14209 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
14213 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
14215 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
14217 hour, space padded (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}); equivalent to @samp{%_H}.
14218 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
14220 hour, space padded (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}); equivalent to @samp{%_I}.
14221 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
14223 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
14225 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
14226 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
14228 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
14229 blank in many locales.
14230 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
14232 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
14233 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
14235 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
14237 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
14239 @cindex epoch, seconds since
14240 @cindex seconds since the epoch
14241 @cindex beginning of time
14242 seconds since the epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC.
14243 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
14244 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
14245 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
14247 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
14248 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
14250 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
14252 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
14254 @w{@acronym{RFC} 2822/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone
14255 (e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}), or nothing if no
14256 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
14257 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
14258 by the @env{TZ} environment variable.
14259 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
14260 by the @option{--date} option.
14262 @w{@acronym{RFC} 3339/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone with
14263 @samp{:} (e.g., @samp{-06:00} or @samp{+05:30}), or nothing if no time
14264 zone is determinable.
14265 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
14267 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
14268 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or nothing if no time zone is
14270 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
14272 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
14273 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or nothing if
14274 no time zone is determinable.
14275 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
14277 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
14278 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
14282 @node Date conversion specifiers
14283 @subsection Date conversion specifiers
14285 @cindex date conversion specifiers
14286 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
14288 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
14292 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
14294 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
14296 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
14298 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
14300 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2005})
14302 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
14303 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2000},
14304 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
14305 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
14307 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
14309 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
14311 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
14313 full date in @acronym{ISO} 8601 format; same as @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
14314 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
14315 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
14318 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number, but without the century
14319 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
14320 as @samp{%y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO} week number (see
14322 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
14324 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number. This has the
14325 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO}
14327 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
14329 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
14330 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
14331 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
14335 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
14337 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
14339 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
14341 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
14342 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
14343 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
14345 @acronym{ISO} week number, that is, the
14346 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
14347 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
14348 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
14349 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
14350 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the @acronym{ISO} 8601
14353 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
14355 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
14356 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
14357 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
14359 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
14361 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
14363 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
14364 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
14365 precedes year @samp{0000}.
14369 @node Literal conversion specifiers
14370 @subsection Literal conversion specifiers
14372 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
14373 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
14375 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
14387 @node Padding and other flags
14388 @subsection Padding and other flags
14390 @cindex numeric field padding
14391 @cindex padding of numeric fields
14392 @cindex fields, padding numeric
14394 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
14395 with zeros, so that, for
14396 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
14397 Seconds since the epoch are not padded, though,
14398 since there is no natural width for them.
14400 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @command{date} recognizes any of the
14401 following optional flags after the @samp{%}:
14405 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
14408 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
14409 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
14411 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
14412 would normally pad with spaces.
14414 Use upper case characters if possible.
14416 Use opposite case characters if possible.
14417 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
14421 Here are some examples of padding:
14424 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
14426 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
14428 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
14432 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, you can specify the field width
14433 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
14434 output of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
14435 the result is written right adjusted and padded to the given
14436 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
14437 a field of width 9.
14439 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
14440 specification. The modifiers are:
14444 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
14445 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
14446 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
14447 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
14451 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
14452 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
14455 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
14456 is available, it is ignored.
14459 @node Setting the time
14460 @subsection Setting the time
14462 @cindex setting the time
14463 @cindex time setting
14464 @cindex appropriate privileges
14466 If given an argument that does not start with @samp{+}, @command{date} sets
14467 the system clock to the date and time specified by that argument (as
14468 described below). You must have appropriate privileges to set the
14469 system clock. Note for changes to persist across a reboot, the
14470 hardware clock may need to be updated from the system clock, which
14471 might not happen automatically on your system.
14473 The argument must consist entirely of digits, which have the following
14486 first two digits of year (optional)
14488 last two digits of year (optional)
14493 Note, the @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be used with an
14494 argument in the above format. The @option{--universal} option may be used
14495 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
14496 relative to Coordinated Universal Time rather than to the local time zone.
14499 @node Options for date
14500 @subsection Options for @command{date}
14502 @cindex @command{date} options
14503 @cindex options for @command{date}
14505 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14509 @item -d @var{datestr}
14510 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
14513 @cindex parsing date strings
14514 @cindex date strings, parsing
14515 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
14518 @opindex next @var{day}
14519 @opindex last @var{day}
14520 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
14521 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
14522 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
14523 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2004-02-27
14524 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
14525 489,392,193 nanoseconds after February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a
14526 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}.@*
14527 Note: input currently must be in locale independent format. E.g., the
14528 LC_TIME=C below is needed to print back the correct date in many locales:
14530 date -d "$(LC_TIME=C date)"
14532 @xref{Date input formats}.
14534 @item -f @var{datefile}
14535 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
14538 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
14539 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
14540 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
14541 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
14544 @item -I[@var{timespec}]
14545 @itemx --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
14546 @opindex -I[@var{timespec}]
14547 @opindex --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
14548 Display the date using the @acronym{ISO} 8601 format, @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
14550 The argument @var{timespec} specifies the number of additional
14551 terms of the time to include. It can be one of the following:
14554 Print just the date. This is the default if @var{timespec} is omitted.
14557 Append the hour of the day to the date.
14560 Append the hours and minutes.
14563 Append the hours, minutes and seconds.
14566 Append the hours, minutes, seconds and nanoseconds.
14569 If showing any time terms, then include the time zone using the format
14572 @item -r @var{file}
14573 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
14575 @opindex --reference
14576 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
14577 instead of the current date and time.
14584 @opindex --rfc-2822
14585 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
14586 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
14590 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
14593 This format conforms to
14594 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2822.txt, Internet
14595 @acronym{RFCs} 2822} and
14596 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc822.txt, 822}, the
14597 current and previous standards for Internet email.
14599 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
14600 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
14601 Display the date using a format specified by
14602 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3339.txt, Internet
14603 @acronym{RFC} 3339}. This is a subset of the @acronym{ISO} 8601
14604 format, except that it also permits applications to use a space rather
14605 than a @samp{T} to separate dates from times. Unlike the other
14606 standard formats, @acronym{RFC} 3339 format is always suitable as
14607 input for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
14608 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
14610 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
14611 It can be one of the following:
14615 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2005-09-14}.
14616 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
14619 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
14620 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
14621 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
14622 hours and thirty minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. This is equivalent to
14623 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
14626 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
14627 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06.998458565+05:30}.
14628 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
14632 @item -s @var{datestr}
14633 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
14636 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
14637 See also @ref{Setting the time}.
14644 @opindex --universal
14645 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
14647 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
14650 Use Coordinated Universal Time (@acronym{UTC}) by operating as if the
14651 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
14653 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (@sc{gmt}) for
14654 historical reasons.
14658 @node Examples of date
14659 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
14661 @cindex examples of @command{date}
14663 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
14664 option in the previous section.
14669 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
14672 date --date='2 days ago'
14676 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
14679 date --date='3 months 1 day'
14683 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
14686 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
14690 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
14696 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
14697 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
14698 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
14701 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
14702 of the month, you can use the (@acronym{GNU} extension)
14703 @samp{-} flag to suppress
14704 the padding altogether:
14707 date -d 1may '+%B %-d
14711 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
14712 non-@acronym{GNU} versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
14715 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
14719 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
14722 date --set='+2 minutes'
14726 To print the date in @acronym{RFC} 2822 format,
14727 use @samp{date --rfc-2822}. Here is some example output:
14730 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
14733 @anchor{%s-examples}
14735 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the epoch
14736 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
14737 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
14738 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
14739 number of the seconds since the epoch for the time two minutes after the
14743 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
14747 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
14748 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
14749 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
14750 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
14751 seconds) behind UTC:
14754 # local time zone used
14755 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
14760 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
14761 represented as seconds since the epoch. But few people can look at
14762 the date @samp{946684800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first second
14763 of the year 2000 in Greenwich, England.''
14766 date --date='2000-01-01 UTC' +%s
14770 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
14771 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
14772 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
14773 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
14774 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
14777 date -u --date=2000-01-01 +%s
14781 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
14782 a more readable form, use a command like this:
14785 # local time zone used
14786 date -d '1970-01-01 UTC 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
14787 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
14790 Or if you do not mind depending on the @samp{@@} feature present since
14791 coreutils 5.3.0, you could shorten this to:
14794 date -d @@946684800 +"%F %T %z"
14795 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
14798 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
14801 date -u -d '1970-01-01 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
14802 2000-01-01 00:00:00 +0000
14808 @node arch invocation
14809 @section @command{arch}: Print machine hardware name
14812 @cindex print machine hardware name
14813 @cindex system information, printing
14815 @command{arch} prints the machine hardware name,
14816 and is equivalent to @samp{uname -m}.
14820 arch [@var{option}]
14823 The program accepts the @ref{Common options} only.
14828 @node nproc invocation
14829 @section @command{nproc}: Print the number of available processors
14832 @cindex Print the number of processors
14833 @cindex system information, printing
14835 Print the number of processing units available to the current process,
14836 which may be less than the number of online processors.
14837 If this information is not accessible, then print the number of
14838 processors installed. If the @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} environment variable is
14839 set, then it will determine the returned value. The result is guaranteed to be
14840 greater than zero. Synopsis:
14843 nproc [@var{option}]
14846 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14852 Print the number of installed processors on the system, which may
14853 be greater than the number online or available to the current process.
14854 The @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} environment variable is not honored in this case.
14856 @item --ignore=@var{number}
14858 If possible, exclude this @var{number} of processing units.
14865 @node uname invocation
14866 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
14869 @cindex print system information
14870 @cindex system information, printing
14872 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
14873 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
14874 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
14877 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
14880 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
14881 printed in this order:
14884 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
14885 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
14888 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
14889 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{release} is
14890 @samp{2.2.18ss.e820-bda652a #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001}:
14894 @result{} Linux dum 2.2.18 #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001 i686@c
14895 unknown unknown GNU/Linux
14899 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14907 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
14908 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
14911 @itemx --hardware-platform
14913 @opindex --hardware-platform
14914 @cindex implementation, hardware
14915 @cindex hardware platform
14916 @cindex platform, hardware
14917 Print the hardware platform name
14918 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
14919 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
14920 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
14926 @cindex machine type
14927 @cindex hardware class
14928 @cindex hardware type
14929 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
14935 @opindex --nodename
14938 @cindex network node name
14939 Print the network node hostname.
14944 @opindex --processor
14945 @cindex host processor type
14946 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
14947 architecture or ISA).
14948 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
14949 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
14952 @itemx --operating-system
14954 @opindex --operating-system
14955 @cindex operating system name
14956 Print the name of the operating system.
14959 @itemx --kernel-release
14961 @opindex --kernel-release
14962 @cindex kernel release
14963 @cindex release of kernel
14964 Print the kernel release.
14967 @itemx --kernel-name
14969 @opindex --kernel-name
14970 @cindex kernel name
14971 @cindex name of kernel
14972 Print the kernel name.
14973 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
14974 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
14975 @acronym{POSIX} specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
14976 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
14977 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
14978 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
14979 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
14983 @itemx --kernel-version
14985 @opindex --kernel-version
14986 @cindex kernel version
14987 @cindex version of kernel
14988 Print the kernel version.
14995 @node hostname invocation
14996 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
14999 @cindex setting the hostname
15000 @cindex printing the hostname
15001 @cindex system name, printing
15002 @cindex appropriate privileges
15004 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
15005 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
15006 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
15010 hostname [@var{name}]
15013 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
15019 @node hostid invocation
15020 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier
15023 @cindex printing the host identifier
15025 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
15026 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
15027 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
15028 @xref{Common options}.
15030 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
15037 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
15038 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
15043 @node uptime invocation
15044 @section @command{uptime}: Print system uptime and load
15047 @cindex printing the system uptime and load
15049 @command{uptime} prints the current time, the system's uptime, the
15050 number of logged-in users and the current load average.
15052 If an argument is specified, it is used as the file to be read
15053 to discover how many users are logged in. If no argument is
15054 specified, a system default is used (@command{uptime --help} indicates
15055 the default setting).
15057 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
15058 @xref{Common options}.
15060 For example, here's what it prints right now on one system I use:
15064 14:07 up 3:35, 3 users, load average: 1.39, 1.15, 1.04
15067 The precise method of calculation of load average varies somewhat
15068 between systems. Some systems calculate it as the average number of
15069 runnable processes over the last 1, 5 and 15 minutes, but some systems
15070 also include processes in the uninterruptible sleep state (that is,
15071 those processes which are waiting for disk I/O). The Linux kernel
15072 includes uninterruptible processes.
15074 @node SELinux context
15075 @chapter SELinux context
15077 @cindex SELinux context
15078 @cindex SELinux, context
15079 @cindex commands for SELinux context
15081 This section describes commands for operations with SELinux
15085 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
15086 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
15089 @node chcon invocation
15090 @section @command{chcon}: Change SELinux context of file
15093 @cindex changing security context
15094 @cindex change SELinux context
15096 @command{chcon} changes the SELinux security context of the selected files.
15100 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{context} @var{file}@dots{}
15101 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-l @var{range}]@c
15102 [-t @var{type}] @var{file}@dots{}
15103 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} --reference=@var{rfile} @var{file}@dots{}
15106 Change the SELinux security context of each @var{file} to @var{context}.
15107 With @option{--reference}, change the security context of each @var{file}
15108 to that of @var{rfile}.
15110 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15115 @itemx --no-dereference
15117 @opindex --no-dereference
15118 @cindex no dereference
15119 Affect symbolic links instead of any referenced file.
15121 @item --reference=@var{rfile}
15122 @opindex --reference
15123 @cindex reference file
15124 Use @var{rfile}'s security context rather than specifying a @var{context} value.
15129 @opindex --recursive
15130 Operate on files and directories recursively.
15133 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
15136 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
15139 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
15146 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
15148 @item -u @var{user}
15149 @itemx --user=@var{user}
15152 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
15154 @item -r @var{role}
15155 @itemx --role=@var{role}
15158 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
15160 @item -t @var{type}
15161 @itemx --type=@var{type}
15164 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
15166 @item -l @var{range}
15167 @itemx --range=@var{range}
15170 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
15176 @node runcon invocation
15177 @section @command{runcon}: Run a command in specified SELinux context
15180 @cindex run with security context
15183 @command{runcon} runs file in specified SELinux security context.
15187 runcon @var{context} @var{command} [@var{args}]
15188 runcon [ -c ] [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-t @var{type}]@c
15189 [-l @var{range}] @var{command} [@var{args}]
15192 Run @var{command} with completely-specified @var{context}, or with
15193 current or transitioned security context modified by one or more of @var{level},
15194 @var{role}, @var{type} and @var{user}.
15196 If none of @option{-c}, @option{-t}, @option{-u}, @option{-r}, or @option{-l}
15197 is specified, the first argument is used as the complete context.
15198 Any additional arguments after @var{command}
15199 are interpreted as arguments to the command.
15201 With neither @var{context} nor @var{command}, print the current
15204 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15212 Compute process transition context before modifying.
15214 @item -u @var{user}
15215 @itemx --user=@var{user}
15218 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
15220 @item -r @var{role}
15221 @itemx --role=@var{role}
15224 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
15226 @item -t @var{type}
15227 @itemx --type=@var{type}
15230 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
15232 @item -l @var{range}
15233 @itemx --range=@var{range}
15236 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
15240 @cindex exit status of @command{runcon}
15244 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
15245 127 if @command{runcon} itself fails or if @var{command} cannot be found
15246 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
15249 @node Modified command invocation
15250 @chapter Modified command invocation
15252 @cindex modified command invocation
15253 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
15254 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
15256 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
15257 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
15261 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
15262 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
15263 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
15264 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
15265 * stdbuf invocation:: Modify buffering of standard streams.
15266 * su invocation:: Modify user and group ID.
15267 * timeout invocation:: Run with time limit.
15271 @node chroot invocation
15272 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
15275 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
15276 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
15278 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
15279 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.@footnote{However,
15280 some systems (e.g., FreeBSD) can be configured to allow certain regular
15281 users to use the @code{chroot} system call, and hence to run this program.
15282 Also, on Cygwin, anyone can run the @command{chroot} command, because the
15283 underlying function is non-privileged due to lack of support in MS-Windows.}
15287 chroot @var{option} @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
15288 chroot @var{option}
15291 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
15292 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
15293 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist) and then runs
15294 @var{command} with optional @var{args}. If @var{command} is not
15295 specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL} environment
15296 variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the @option{-i} option.
15297 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
15298 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
15300 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15301 Options must precede operands.
15305 @itemx --userspec=@var{user}[:@var{group}]
15306 @opindex --userspec
15307 By default, @var{command} is run with the same credentials
15308 as the invoking process.
15309 Use this option to run it as a different @var{user} and/or with a
15310 different primary @var{group}.
15312 @itemx --groups=@var{groups}
15314 Use this option to specify the supplementary @var{groups} to be
15315 used by the new process.
15316 The items in the list (names or numeric IDs) must be separated by commas.
15320 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
15321 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
15322 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
15323 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
15324 your new root directory.
15326 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
15327 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
15330 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
15333 Then you'll see output like this:
15338 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
15341 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
15342 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
15343 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
15344 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
15345 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
15346 device files), copy them into place, too.
15348 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
15352 125 if @command{chroot} itself fails
15353 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
15354 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
15355 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
15359 @node env invocation
15360 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
15363 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
15364 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
15365 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
15367 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
15370 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
15371 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
15375 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
15376 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
15377 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
15378 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
15379 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
15380 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
15382 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
15383 characters other than @samp{=} and @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}.
15384 However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
15385 consist solely of underscores, digits, and @acronym{ASCII} letters,
15386 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
15387 work well with other names.
15390 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
15391 specifies the program to invoke; it is
15392 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
15393 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
15394 The program should not be a special built-in utility
15395 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
15397 Modifications to @env{PATH} take effect prior to searching for
15398 @var{command}. Use caution when reducing @env{PATH}; behavior is
15399 not portable when @env{PATH} is undefined or omits key directories
15400 such as @file{/bin}.
15402 In the rare case that a utility contains a @samp{=} in the name, the
15403 only way to disambiguate it from a variable assignment is to use an
15404 intermediate command for @var{command}, and pass the problematic
15405 program name via @var{args}. For example, if @file{./prog=} is an
15406 executable in the current @env{PATH}:
15409 env prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
15410 env ./prog= true # runs 'true', with ./prog= in environment
15411 env -- prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
15412 env sh -c '\prog= true' # runs 'prog=' with argument 'true'
15413 env sh -c 'exec "$@@"' sh prog= true # also runs 'prog='
15416 @cindex environment, printing
15418 If no command name is specified following the environment
15419 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
15420 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
15422 For some examples, suppose the environment passed to @command{env}
15423 contains @samp{LOGNAME=rms}, @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and
15424 @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}:
15429 Output the current environment.
15431 $ env | LC_ALL=C sort
15434 PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks
15438 Run @command{foo} with a reduced environment, preserving only the
15439 original @env{PATH} to avoid problems in locating @command{foo}.
15441 env - PATH="$PATH" foo
15445 Run @command{foo} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=rms},
15446 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and guarantees
15447 that @command{foo} was found in the file system rather than as a shell
15454 Run @command{nemacs} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=foo},
15455 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and
15456 @samp{DISPLAY=gnu:0}.
15458 env DISPLAY=gnu:0 LOGNAME=foo nemacs
15462 Attempt to run the program @command{/energy/--} (as that is the only
15463 possible path search result); if the command exists, the environment
15464 will contain @samp{LOGNAME=rms} and @samp{PATH=/energy}, and the
15465 arguments will be @samp{e=mc2}, @samp{bar}, and @samp{baz}.
15467 env -u EDITOR PATH=/energy -- e=mc2 bar baz
15473 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15474 Options must precede operands.
15480 @item -u @var{name}
15481 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
15484 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
15489 @itemx --ignore-environment
15492 @opindex --ignore-environment
15493 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
15497 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
15501 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
15502 125 if @command{env} itself fails
15503 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
15504 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
15505 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
15509 @node nice invocation
15510 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
15514 @cindex scheduling, affecting
15515 @cindex appropriate privileges
15517 @command{nice} prints or modifies a process's @dfn{niceness},
15518 a parameter that affects whether the process is scheduled favorably.
15522 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
15525 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
15526 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
15527 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
15529 Niceness values range at least from @minus{}20 (process has high priority
15530 and gets more resources, thus slowing down other processes) through 19
15531 (process has lower priority and runs slowly itself, but has less impact
15532 on the speed of other running processes). Some systems
15533 may have a wider range of nicenesses; conversely, other systems may
15534 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
15535 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
15536 minimum or maximum supported value.
15538 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
15539 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
15540 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
15541 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
15542 terminology, @acronym{POSIX} defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
15543 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the nonnegative difference
15544 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
15545 conforms to @acronym{POSIX}, its documentation and diagnostics use the
15546 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
15548 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
15549 built-in utilities}).
15551 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{nice}
15553 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15554 Options must precede operands.
15557 @item -n @var{adjustment}
15558 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
15560 @opindex --adjustment
15561 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
15562 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
15563 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
15566 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
15567 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
15568 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
15572 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
15576 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
15577 125 if @command{nice} itself fails
15578 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
15579 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
15580 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
15583 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
15586 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
15589 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
15590 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
15592 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
15603 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
15604 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
15605 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
15609 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
15613 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
15614 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
15617 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
15621 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
15625 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
15627 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
15632 @node nohup invocation
15633 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
15636 @cindex hangups, immunity to
15637 @cindex immunity to hangups
15638 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
15641 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
15642 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
15646 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
15649 If standard input is a terminal, it is redirected from
15650 @file{/dev/null} so that terminal sessions do not mistakenly consider
15651 the terminal to be used by the command. This is a @acronym{GNU}
15652 extension; programs intended to be portable to non-@acronym{GNU} hosts
15653 should use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{} </dev/null}
15657 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
15658 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
15659 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
15660 command is not run.
15661 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
15662 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
15663 regardless of the current umask settings.
15665 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
15666 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
15667 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
15668 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
15669 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
15671 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
15672 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
15676 nohup make > make.log
15679 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
15680 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
15681 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
15682 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
15683 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
15685 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
15686 built-in utilities}).
15688 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
15689 options}. Options must precede operands.
15691 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
15695 125 if @command{nohup} itself fails, and @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set
15696 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
15697 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
15698 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
15701 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, internal failures give status 127
15705 @node stdbuf invocation
15706 @section @command{stdbuf}: Run a command with modified I/O stream buffering
15709 @cindex standard streams, buffering
15710 @cindex line buffered
15712 @command{stdbuf} allows one to modify the buffering operations of the
15713 three standard I/O streams associated with a program. Synopsis:
15716 stdbuf @var{option}@dots{} @var{command}
15719 @var{command} must start with the name of a program that
15722 uses the ISO C @code{FILE} streams for input/output (note the
15723 programs @command{dd} and @command{cat} don't do that),
15726 does not adjust the buffering of its standard streams (note the
15727 program @command{tee} is not in this category).
15730 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
15733 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15737 @item -i @var{mode}
15738 @itemx --input=@var{mode}
15741 Adjust the standard input stream buffering.
15743 @item -o @var{mode}
15744 @itemx --output=@var{mode}
15747 Adjust the standard output stream buffering.
15749 @item -e @var{mode}
15750 @itemx --error=@var{mode}
15753 Adjust the standard error stream buffering.
15757 The @var{mode} can be specified as follows:
15762 Set the stream to line buffered mode.
15763 In this mode data is coalesced until a newline is output or
15764 input is read from any stream attached to a terminal device.
15765 This option is invalid with standard input.
15768 Disable buffering of the selected stream.
15769 In this mode, data is output immediately and only the
15770 amount of data requested is read from input.
15771 Note the difference in function for input and output.
15772 Disabling buffering for input will not influence the responsiveness
15773 or blocking behavior of the stream input functions.
15774 For example @code{fread} will still block until @code{EOF} or error,
15775 even if the underlying @code{read} returns less data than requested.
15778 Specify the size of the buffer to use in fully buffered mode.
15779 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
15783 @cindex exit status of @command{stdbuf}
15787 125 if @command{stdbuf} itself fails
15788 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
15789 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
15790 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
15794 @node su invocation
15795 @section @command{su}: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
15798 @cindex substitute user and group IDs
15799 @cindex user ID, switching
15800 @cindex super-user, becoming
15801 @cindex root, becoming
15803 @command{su} allows one user to temporarily become another user. It runs a
15804 command (often an interactive shell) with the real and effective user
15805 ID, group ID, and supplemental groups of a given @var{user}. Synopsis:
15808 su [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
15811 @cindex passwd entry, and @command{su} shell
15813 @flindex /etc/passwd
15814 If no @var{user} is given, the default is @code{root}, the super-user.
15815 The shell to use is taken from @var{user}'s @code{passwd} entry, or
15816 @file{/bin/sh} if none is specified there. If @var{user} has a
15817 password, @command{su} prompts for the password unless run by a user with
15818 effective user ID of zero (the super-user).
15824 @cindex login shell
15825 By default, @command{su} does not change the current directory.
15826 It sets the environment variables @env{HOME} and @env{SHELL}
15827 from the password entry for @var{user}, and if @var{user} is not
15828 the super-user, sets @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME} to @var{user}.
15829 By default, the shell is not a login shell.
15831 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
15834 @cindex @option{-su}
15835 GNU @command{su} does not treat @file{/bin/sh} or any other shells specially
15836 (e.g., by setting @code{argv[0]} to @option{-su}, passing @option{-c} only
15837 to certain shells, etc.).
15840 @command{su} can optionally be compiled to use @code{syslog} to report
15841 failed, and optionally successful, @command{su} attempts. (If the system
15842 supports @code{syslog}.) However, GNU @command{su} does not check if the
15843 user is a member of the @code{wheel} group; see below.
15845 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15848 @item -c @var{command}
15849 @itemx --command=@var{command}
15852 Pass @var{command}, a single command line to run, to the shell with
15853 a @option{-c} option instead of starting an interactive shell.
15860 @cindex file name pattern expansion, disabled
15861 @cindex globbing, disabled
15862 Pass the @option{-f} option to the shell. This probably only makes sense
15863 if the shell run is @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}, for which the @option{-f}
15864 option prevents reading the startup file (@file{.cshrc}). With
15865 Bourne-like shells, the @option{-f} option disables file name pattern
15866 expansion (globbing), which is not likely to be useful.
15874 @c other variables already indexed above
15877 @cindex login shell, creating
15878 Make the shell a login shell. This means the following. Unset all
15879 environment variables except @env{TERM}, @env{HOME}, and @env{SHELL}
15880 (which are set as described above), and @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME}
15881 (which are set, even for the super-user, as described above), and set
15882 @env{PATH} to a compiled-in default value. Change to @var{user}'s home
15883 directory. Prepend @samp{-} to the shell's name, intended to make it
15884 read its login startup file(s).
15888 @itemx --preserve-environment
15891 @opindex --preserve-environment
15892 @cindex environment, preserving
15893 @flindex /etc/shells
15894 @cindex restricted shell
15895 Do not change the environment variables @env{HOME}, @env{USER},
15896 @env{LOGNAME}, or @env{SHELL}. Run the shell given in the environment
15897 variable @env{SHELL} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd
15898 entry, unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and
15899 @var{user}'s shell is restricted. A @dfn{restricted shell} is one that
15900 is not listed in the file @file{/etc/shells}, or in a compiled-in list
15901 if that file does not exist. Parts of what this option does can be
15902 overridden by @option{--login} and @option{--shell}.
15904 @item -s @var{shell}
15905 @itemx --shell=@var{shell}
15908 Run @var{shell} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd entry,
15909 unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and @var{user}'s
15910 shell is restricted (see @option{-m} just above).
15914 @cindex exit status of @command{su}
15918 125 if @command{su} itself fails
15919 126 if subshell is found but cannot be invoked
15920 127 if subshell cannot be found
15921 the exit status of the subshell otherwise
15924 @cindex wheel group, not supported
15925 @cindex group wheel, not supported
15927 @subsection Why GNU @command{su} does not support the @samp{wheel} group
15929 (This section is by Richard Stallman.)
15933 Sometimes a few of the users try to hold total power over all the
15934 rest. For example, in 1984, a few users at the MIT AI lab decided to
15935 seize power by changing the operator password on the Twenex system and
15936 keeping it secret from everyone else. (I was able to thwart this coup
15937 and give power back to the users by patching the kernel, but I
15938 wouldn't know how to do that in Unix.)
15940 However, occasionally the rulers do tell someone. Under the usual
15941 @command{su} mechanism, once someone learns the root password who
15942 sympathizes with the ordinary users, he or she can tell the rest. The
15943 ``wheel group'' feature would make this impossible, and thus cement the
15944 power of the rulers.
15946 I'm on the side of the masses, not that of the rulers. If you are
15947 used to supporting the bosses and sysadmins in whatever they do, you
15948 might find this idea strange at first.
15951 @node timeout invocation
15952 @section @command{timeout}: Run a command with a time limit
15956 @cindex run commands with bounded time
15958 @command{timeout} runs the given @var{command} and kills it if it is
15959 still running after the specified time interval. Synopsis:
15962 timeout [@var{option}] @var{duration} @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
15965 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
15966 built-in utilities}).
15968 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15969 Options must precede operands.
15972 @itemx --foreground
15973 @opindex --foreground
15974 Don't create a separate background program group, so that
15975 the managed @var{command} can use the foreground TTY normally.
15976 This is needed to support timing out commands not started
15977 directly from an interactive shell, in two situations.
15980 @var{command} is interactive and needs to read from the terminal for example
15982 the user wants to support sending signals directly to @var{command}
15983 from the terminal (like Ctrl-C for example)
15986 Note in this mode of operation, any children of @var{command}
15987 will not be timed out.
15989 @item -k @var{duration}
15990 @itemx --kill-after=@var{duration}
15992 @opindex --kill-after
15993 Ensure the monitored @var{command} is killed by also sending a @samp{KILL}
15994 signal, after the specified @var{duration}. Without this option, if the
15995 selected signal proves not to be fatal, @command{timeout} does not kill
15998 @item -s @var{signal}
15999 @itemx --signal=@var{signal}
16002 Send this @var{signal} to @var{command} on timeout, rather than the
16003 default @samp{TERM} signal. @var{signal} may be a name like @samp{HUP}
16004 or a number. @xref{Signal specifications}.
16008 @var{duration} is a floating point number followed by an optional unit:
16010 @samp{s} for seconds (the default)
16011 @samp{m} for minutes
16015 A duration of 0 disables the associated timeout.
16016 Note that the actual timeout duration is dependent on system conditions,
16017 which should be especially considered when specifying sub-second timeouts.
16019 @cindex exit status of @command{timeout}
16023 124 if @var{command} times out
16024 125 if @command{timeout} itself fails
16025 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16026 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16027 137 if @var{command} is sent the KILL(9) signal (128+9)
16028 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16032 @node Process control
16033 @chapter Process control
16035 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
16036 @cindex commands for controlling processes
16039 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
16043 @node kill invocation
16044 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
16047 @cindex send a signal to processes
16049 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
16050 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
16051 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
16054 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
16055 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
16058 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{kill}
16060 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
16061 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
16062 is @samp{TERM}. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
16063 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
16064 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
16066 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
16067 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
16068 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
16069 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
16070 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
16071 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
16072 value of @var{pid}.
16074 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
16075 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
16078 If a negative @var{pid} argument is desired as the first one, it
16079 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
16080 @acronym{POSIX}, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
16081 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
16090 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
16091 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
16093 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
16094 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
16095 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
16096 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
16097 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
16098 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
16099 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
16100 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
16101 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
16102 and if there is no output error.
16104 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
16105 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
16107 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
16108 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
16109 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
16110 @samp{SIG}. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
16111 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
16112 ambiguity with lower case option letters.
16113 @xref{Signal specifications}, for a list of supported
16114 signal names and numbers.
16119 @cindex delaying commands
16120 @cindex commands for delaying
16122 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
16125 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
16129 @node sleep invocation
16130 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
16133 @cindex delay for a specified time
16135 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
16136 the values of the command line arguments.
16140 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
16144 Each argument is a number followed by an optional unit; the default
16145 is seconds. The units are:
16158 Historical implementations of @command{sleep} have required that
16159 @var{number} be an integer, and only accepted a single argument
16160 without a suffix. However, GNU @command{sleep} accepts
16161 arbitrary floating point numbers. @xref{Floating point}.
16163 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16166 @c sleep is a shell built-in at least with Solaris 11's /bin/sh
16167 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{sleep}
16172 @node Numeric operations
16173 @chapter Numeric operations
16175 @cindex numeric operations
16176 These programs do numerically-related operations.
16179 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
16180 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
16184 @node factor invocation
16185 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
16188 @cindex prime factors
16190 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopses:
16193 factor [@var{number}]@dots{}
16194 factor @var{option}
16197 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
16198 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
16200 The @command{factor} command supports only a small number of options:
16204 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
16208 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
16212 Factoring the product of the eighth and ninth Mersenne primes
16213 takes about 30 milliseconds of CPU time on a 2.2 GHz Athlon.
16216 M8=$(echo 2^31-1|bc)
16217 M9=$(echo 2^61-1|bc)
16218 n=$(echo "$M8 * $M9" | bc)
16219 /usr/bin/time -f %U factor $n
16220 4951760154835678088235319297: 2147483647 2305843009213693951
16224 Similarly, factoring the eighth Fermat number @math{2^{256}+1} takes
16225 about 20 seconds on the same machine.
16227 Factoring large numbers is, in general, hard. The Pollard Rho
16228 algorithm used by @command{factor} is particularly effective for
16229 numbers with relatively small factors. If you wish to factor large
16230 numbers which do not have small factors (for example, numbers which
16231 are the product of two large primes), other methods are far better.
16233 If @command{factor} is built without using GNU MP, only
16234 single-precision arithmetic is available, and so large numbers
16235 (typically @math{2^{64}} and above) will not be supported. The single-precision
16236 code uses an algorithm which is designed for factoring smaller
16242 @node seq invocation
16243 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
16246 @cindex numeric sequences
16247 @cindex sequence of numbers
16249 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
16252 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
16253 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
16254 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
16257 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
16258 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
16259 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
16260 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
16261 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
16262 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
16263 Floating-point numbers may be specified. @xref{Floating point}.
16265 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16266 Options must precede operands.
16269 @item -f @var{format}
16270 @itemx --format=@var{format}
16271 @opindex -f @var{format}
16272 @opindex --format=@var{format}
16273 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
16274 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
16275 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
16276 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
16277 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}.
16278 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
16279 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
16280 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
16281 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
16282 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
16283 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
16285 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
16286 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
16287 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
16288 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
16289 the default format is @samp{%g}.
16291 @item -s @var{string}
16292 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
16293 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
16294 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
16295 The output always terminates with a newline.
16298 @itemx --equal-width
16299 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
16300 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
16301 decimal representation.
16302 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
16306 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
16309 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
16315 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
16316 to perform the conversion:
16319 $ printf '%x\n' $(seq 1048575 1024 1050623)
16325 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
16326 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
16329 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
16335 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
16338 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
16339 at least @math{2^{53}}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
16340 differ depending on your floating-point implementation.
16341 @xref{Floating point}. A common
16342 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @math{2^{64}},
16343 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
16346 $ seq 18446744073709551616 1 18446744073709551618
16347 18446744073709551616
16348 18446744073709551616
16349 18446744073709551618
16352 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
16353 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
16354 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
16355 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
16358 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
16361 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
16366 @node File permissions
16367 @chapter File permissions
16370 @include parse-datetime.texi
16374 @node Opening the software toolbox
16375 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
16377 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
16378 @uref{http://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
16379 @cite{What's GNU?} column of the June 1994 @cite{Linux Journal}}.
16380 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
16383 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
16384 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
16385 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
16386 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
16387 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
16388 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
16389 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
16393 @node Toolbox introduction
16394 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
16396 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
16397 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system
16399 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
16400 of program development and usage.
16402 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
16403 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which Linux and GNU are
16404 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
16405 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
16406 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
16407 for solving many kinds of problems.
16409 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
16410 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
16411 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
16412 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
16413 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
16415 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
16416 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
16417 tools---a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
16418 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
16419 with the handle of his screwdriver.
16421 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
16422 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
16423 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
16428 difficult to write,
16431 difficult to maintain and
16435 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
16438 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
16439 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
16440 simpler to design, write, and get right---they only do one thing.
16442 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
16443 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
16444 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
16445 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
16446 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
16447 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
16448 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
16449 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
16450 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
16452 @node I/O redirection
16453 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
16455 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
16456 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
16457 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
16458 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
16459 data source is a disk file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
16460 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
16461 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
16462 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
16463 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
16466 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
16469 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
16472 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
16473 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
16474 it is in the desired form.
16476 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
16477 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
16478 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
16479 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
16480 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
16481 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
16482 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
16483 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
16484 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
16486 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
16487 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
16488 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
16489 lines delimited by the @acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf} (Line Feed) character,
16490 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
16491 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
16492 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
16493 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
16494 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
16495 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
16496 data with a text editor.)
16498 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
16499 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
16500 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
16501 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
16502 for the full story.
16504 @node The who command
16505 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
16507 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
16508 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
16509 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
16514 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
16515 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
16516 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
16517 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
16520 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
16521 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
16522 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
16523 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
16524 but the data is not all that exciting.
16526 @node The cut command
16527 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
16529 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
16530 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
16531 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
16532 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
16536 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
16539 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
16542 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
16543 @print{} root:Operator
16545 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
16546 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
16550 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
16551 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
16552 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
16553 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
16555 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
16566 @node The sort command
16567 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
16569 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
16570 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
16571 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
16574 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
16575 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
16576 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
16577 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
16578 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
16581 @node The uniq command
16582 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
16584 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
16585 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
16586 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
16587 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
16588 standard input. It prints only one
16589 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
16590 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
16591 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
16594 @node Putting the tools together
16595 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
16597 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
16598 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a
16600 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
16601 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
16604 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
16605 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
16606 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
16607 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
16608 by generating just a list of logged on users:
16618 Next, sort the list:
16621 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
16628 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
16631 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
16637 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
16638 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
16639 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
16641 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it
16643 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
16644 or @code{root}, prompt):
16647 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
16648 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
16650 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
16653 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
16654 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
16655 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
16656 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
16657 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
16658 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
16659 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
16662 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
16663 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
16664 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
16666 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
16667 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
16668 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
16670 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
16671 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
16672 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
16675 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
16676 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
16678 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
16679 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
16680 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
16684 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
16685 @print{} this example has mixed case!
16688 There are several options of interest:
16692 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
16693 operations apply to characters not in the given set
16696 delete characters in the first set from the output
16699 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
16702 We will be using all three options in a moment.
16704 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
16705 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
16706 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
16707 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
16708 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
16709 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
16710 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
16732 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
16733 instead of a regular file.
16735 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
16736 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
16739 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
16740 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
16743 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
16746 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
16747 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
16751 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
16754 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
16755 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
16756 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
16757 be left alone. (The @acronym{ASCII} tab character should also be included for
16758 good measure in a production script.)
16760 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
16761 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
16762 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
16763 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
16766 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
16767 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
16770 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
16771 multiple newline characters in the output into just one. This helps us
16772 avoid blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
16773 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
16774 typing in all of a command.)
16776 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
16777 case. We're ready to count each word:
16780 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
16781 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
16784 At this point, the data might look something like this:
16797 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
16798 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
16799 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
16803 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
16806 reverse the order of the sort
16809 The final pipeline looks like this:
16812 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
16813 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
16822 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
16823 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
16824 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
16825 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
16827 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
16828 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
16829 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
16830 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
16831 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/dict/words}.
16832 On my GNU/Linux system,@footnote{Redhat Linux 6.1, for the November 2000
16833 revision of this article.}
16834 this is a sorted, 45,402 word dictionary.
16836 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
16837 a sorted list of words, one per line:
16840 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
16841 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
16844 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
16845 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
16848 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
16849 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
16850 > comm -23 - /usr/dict/words
16853 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
16854 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
16855 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
16856 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
16857 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
16858 spelling checker on Unix.
16860 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
16864 search files for text that matches a regular expression
16867 count lines, words, characters
16870 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
16873 the stream editor, an advanced tool
16876 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
16879 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
16880 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
16881 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
16882 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
16888 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
16891 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
16892 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
16893 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
16896 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
16897 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
16900 Let someone else do the hard part.
16903 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
16904 appropriate tool, build one.
16907 As of this writing, all the programs we've discussed are available via
16908 anonymous @command{ftp} from: @*
16909 @uref{ftp://gnudist.gnu.org/textutils/textutils-1.22.tar.gz}. (There may
16910 be more recent versions available now.)
16912 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
16913 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
16914 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
16915 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
16916 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
16917 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
16918 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
16919 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
16920 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
16923 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
16924 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
16925 still in print and are well worth
16926 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
16927 how I view programming.
16929 The programs in both books are available from
16930 @uref{http://cm.bell-labs.com/who/bwk, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
16931 For a number of years, there was an active
16932 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
16933 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
16934 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
16935 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
16937 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
16938 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
16939 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
16940 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
16941 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
16943 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
16944 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
16946 @node GNU Free Documentation License
16947 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
16951 @node Concept index
16958 @c Local variables:
16959 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32